Mercurial > emacs
annotate doc/misc/org.texi @ 87768:2dfbe4c86ab7
(easy-menu-avoid-duplicate-keys): New var.
(easy-menu-create-menu, easy-menu-convert-item-1): Use it to avoid
using the same key for different menu entries.
author | Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca> |
---|---|
date | Tue, 15 Jan 2008 22:33:05 +0000 |
parents | 3d431f1997d8 |
children | 22ad67b23797 |
rev | line source |
---|---|
84308 | 1 \input texinfo |
2 @c %**start of header | |
84329
3d431f1997d8
(setfilename): Go up one more level to ../../info.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
84308
diff
changeset
|
3 @setfilename ../../info/org |
84308 | 4 @settitle Org Mode Manual |
5 | |
6 @set VERSION 5.07 | |
7 @set DATE August 2007 | |
8 | |
9 @dircategory Emacs | |
10 @direntry | |
11 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer | |
12 @end direntry | |
13 | |
14 @c Version and Contact Info | |
15 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/org/,maintainers webpage} | |
16 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik | |
17 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik | |
18 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{dominik at science dot uva dot nl} | |
19 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:dominik at science dot uva dot nl,contact the maintainer} | |
20 @c %**end of header | |
21 @finalout | |
22 | |
23 @c Macro definitions | |
24 | |
25 @c Subheadings inside a table. | |
26 @macro tsubheading{text} | |
27 @ifinfo | |
28 @subsubheading \text\ | |
29 @end ifinfo | |
30 @ifnotinfo | |
31 @item @b{\text\} | |
32 @end ifnotinfo | |
33 @end macro | |
34 | |
35 @copying | |
36 This manual is for Org-mode (version @value{VERSION}). | |
37 | |
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation | |
39 | |
40 @quotation | |
41 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document | |
42 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or | |
43 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no | |
44 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' | |
45 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the | |
46 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation | |
47 License.'' | |
48 | |
49 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify | |
50 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free | |
51 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.'' | |
52 @end quotation | |
53 @end copying | |
54 | |
55 @titlepage | |
56 @title Org Mode Manual | |
57 | |
58 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION} | |
59 @author by Carsten Dominik | |
60 | |
61 @c The following two commands start the copyright page. | |
62 @page | |
63 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll | |
64 @insertcopying | |
65 @end titlepage | |
66 | |
67 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning. | |
68 @contents | |
69 | |
70 @ifnottex | |
71 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir) | |
72 @top Org Mode Manual | |
73 | |
74 @insertcopying | |
75 @end ifnottex | |
76 | |
77 @menu | |
78 * Introduction:: Getting started | |
79 * Document structure:: A tree works like your brain | |
80 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting | |
81 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context | |
82 * TODO items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item | |
83 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags | |
84 * Properties and columns:: | |
85 * Timestamps:: Assign date and time to items | |
86 * Agenda views:: Collecting information into views | |
87 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX fragments and formulas | |
88 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes | |
89 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org-mode files | |
90 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere | |
91 * Extensions and Hacking:: It is possible to write add-on code | |
92 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org-mode came into being | |
93 * Index:: The fast road to specific information | |
94 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described | |
95 | |
96 @detailmenu | |
97 --- The Detailed Node Listing --- | |
98 | |
99 Introduction | |
100 | |
101 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org-mode does | |
102 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org-mode | |
103 * Activation:: How to activate Org-mode for certain buffers. | |
104 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc. | |
105 | |
106 Document Structure | |
107 | |
108 * Outlines:: Org-mode is based on outline-mode | |
109 * Headlines:: How to typeset org-tree headlines | |
110 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified | |
111 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines | |
112 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines | |
113 * Archiving:: Move done task trees to a different place | |
114 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context | |
115 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry | |
116 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away | |
117 * orgstruct-mode:: Structure editing outside Org-mode | |
118 | |
119 Archiving | |
120 | |
121 * ARCHIVE tag:: Marking a tree as inactive | |
122 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file | |
123 | |
124 Tables | |
125 | |
126 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables | |
127 * Narrow columns:: Stop wasting space in tables | |
128 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines | |
129 * orgtbl-mode:: The table editor as minor mode | |
130 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities. | |
131 | |
132 The spreadsheet | |
133 | |
134 * References:: How to refer to another field or range | |
135 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff | |
136 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp | |
137 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field | |
138 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column | |
139 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas | |
140 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields | |
141 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc | |
142 | |
143 Hyperlinks | |
144 | |
145 * Link format:: How links in Org-mode are formatted | |
146 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file | |
147 * External links:: URL-like links to the world | |
148 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following | |
149 * Using links outside Org-mode:: Linking from my C source code? | |
150 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links | |
151 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location | |
152 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough | |
153 * Remember:: Org-trees store quick notes | |
154 | |
155 Internal links | |
156 | |
157 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text. | |
158 | |
159 Remember | |
160 | |
161 * Setting up remember:: Some code for .emacs to get things going | |
162 * Remember templates:: Define the outline of different note types | |
163 * Storing notes:: Directly get the note to where it belongs | |
164 | |
165 TODO items | |
166 | |
167 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries | |
168 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments | |
169 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others | |
170 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces | |
171 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists | |
172 | |
173 Extended use of TODO keywords | |
174 | |
175 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps | |
176 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred the rest | |
177 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way | |
178 * Per file keywords:: Different files, different requirements | |
179 | |
180 Tags | |
181 | |
182 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline | |
183 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline | |
184 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags | |
185 | |
186 Properties and Columns | |
187 | |
188 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out | |
189 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features | |
190 * Property searches:: Matching property values | |
191 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing | |
192 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers | |
193 | |
194 Column View | |
195 | |
196 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property | |
197 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view | |
198 | |
199 Defining Columns | |
200 | |
201 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid? | |
202 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column | |
203 | |
204 Timestamps | |
205 | |
206 * Time stamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry | |
207 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps | |
208 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work | |
209 * Progress logging:: Documenting when what work was done. | |
210 | |
211 Creating timestamps | |
212 | |
213 * The date/time prompt:: How org-mode helps you entering date and time | |
214 * Custom time format:: Making dates look differently | |
215 | |
216 Deadlines and Scheduling | |
217 | |
218 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items | |
219 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again | |
220 | |
221 Progress Logging | |
222 | |
223 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE? | |
224 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change? | |
225 * Clocking work time:: When exactly did you work on this item? | |
226 | |
227 Agenda Views | |
228 | |
229 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information | |
230 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views | |
231 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box? | |
232 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display | |
233 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of org trees | |
234 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views | |
235 | |
236 The built-in agenda views | |
237 | |
238 * Weekly/Daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks | |
239 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items | |
240 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search | |
241 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file | |
242 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review | |
243 | |
244 Presentation and sorting | |
245 | |
246 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal | |
247 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time | |
248 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things | |
249 | |
250 Custom agenda views | |
251 | |
252 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often | |
253 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer | |
254 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules | |
255 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing agendas to files. | |
256 * Extracting Agenda Information for other programs:: | |
257 | |
258 Embedded LaTeX | |
259 | |
260 * Math symbols:: TeX macros for symbols and Greek letters | |
261 * Subscripts and Superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text | |
262 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy | |
263 * Processing LaTeX fragments:: Previewing LaTeX processing | |
264 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas | |
265 | |
266 Exporting | |
267 | |
268 * ASCII export:: Exporting to plain ASCII | |
269 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML | |
270 * LaTeX export:: Exporting to LaTeX | |
271 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO | |
272 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format | |
273 * Text interpretation:: How the exporter looks at the file | |
274 | |
275 HTML export | |
276 | |
277 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke LaTeX export | |
278 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode | |
279 * Links:: Transformation of links for HTML | |
280 * Images:: How to include images | |
281 * CSS support:: Changing the appearence of the output | |
282 | |
283 LaTeX export | |
284 | |
285 * LaTeX export commands:: How to invoke LaTeX export | |
286 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal LaTeX code | |
287 | |
288 Text interpretation by the exporter | |
289 | |
290 * Comment lines:: Some lines will not be exported | |
291 * Initial text:: Text before the first headline | |
292 * Footnotes:: Numbers like [1] | |
293 * Enhancing text:: Subscripts, symbols and more | |
294 * Export options:: How to influence the export settings | |
295 | |
296 Publishing | |
297 | |
298 * Configuration:: Defining projects | |
299 * Sample configuration:: Example projects | |
300 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands | |
301 | |
302 Configuration | |
303 | |
304 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable | |
305 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there | |
306 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project? | |
307 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing | |
308 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export | |
309 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing? | |
310 * Project page index:: Publishing a list of project files | |
311 | |
312 Sample configuration | |
313 | |
314 * Simple example:: One-component publishing | |
315 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example | |
316 | |
317 Miscellaneous | |
318 | |
319 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need | |
320 * Customization:: Adapting Org-mode to your taste | |
321 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS | |
322 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c | |
323 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline | |
324 * TTY keys:: Using Org-mode on a tty | |
325 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages | |
326 * Bugs:: Things which do not work perfectly | |
327 | |
328 Interaction with other packages | |
329 | |
330 * Cooperation:: Packages Org-mode cooperates with | |
331 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts | |
332 | |
333 Extensions, Hooks and Hacking | |
334 | |
335 * Extensions:: Existing 3rd-part extensions | |
336 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types | |
337 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs | |
338 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks | |
339 * Special agenda views:: Customized views | |
340 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties | |
341 | |
342 Tables in arbitrary syntax | |
343 | |
344 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving | |
345 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial | |
346 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify | |
347 | |
348 @end detailmenu | |
349 @end menu | |
350 | |
351 @node Introduction, Document structure, Top, Top | |
352 @chapter Introduction | |
353 @cindex introduction | |
354 | |
355 @menu | |
356 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org-mode does | |
357 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org-mode | |
358 * Activation:: How to activate Org-mode for certain buffers. | |
359 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc. | |
360 @end menu | |
361 | |
362 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction | |
363 @section Summary | |
364 @cindex summary | |
365 | |
366 Org-mode is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing | |
367 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system. | |
368 | |
369 Org-mode develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain | |
370 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org-mode is | |
371 implemented on top of outline-mode, which makes it possible to keep the | |
372 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and | |
373 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created | |
374 with a built-in table editor. Org-mode supports TODO items, deadlines, | |
375 time stamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an | |
376 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar | |
377 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails, | |
378 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects. | |
379 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org-mode file can be exported as a | |
380 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (todo and agenda items only) as an | |
381 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of | |
382 linked webpages. | |
383 | |
384 An important design aspect that distinguishes Org-mode from for example | |
385 Planner/Muse is that it encourages to store every piece of information | |
386 only once. In Planner, you have project pages, day pages and possibly | |
387 other files, duplicating some information such as tasks. In Org-mode, | |
388 you only have notes files. In your notes you mark entries as tasks, | |
389 label them with tags and timestamps. All necessary lists like a | |
390 schedule for the day, the agenda for a meeting, tasks lists selected by | |
391 tags etc are created dynamically when you need them. | |
392 | |
393 Org-mode keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should | |
394 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not | |
395 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need | |
396 it. Org-mode is a toolbox and can be used in different ways, for | |
397 example as: | |
398 | |
399 @example | |
400 @r{@bullet{} outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing} | |
401 @r{@bullet{} ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes} | |
402 @r{@bullet{} ASCII table editor with spreadsheet-like capabilities} | |
403 @r{@bullet{} TODO list editor} | |
404 @r{@bullet{} full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling} | |
405 @r{@bullet{} environment to implement David Allen's GTD system} | |
406 @r{@bullet{} a basic database application} | |
407 @r{@bullet{} simple hypertext system, with HTML export} | |
408 @r{@bullet{} publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages} | |
409 @end example | |
410 | |
411 Org-mode's automatic, context sensitive table editor with spreadsheet | |
412 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the | |
413 minor Orgtbl-mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain | |
414 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in La@TeX{}. The structure | |
415 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org-mode with | |
416 the minor Orgstruct-mode. | |
417 | |
418 @cindex FAQ | |
419 There is a website for Org-mode which provides links to the newest | |
420 version of Org-mode, as well as additional information, frequently asked | |
421 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials etc. This page is located at | |
422 @uref{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/org/}. | |
423 | |
424 @page | |
425 | |
426 | |
427 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction | |
428 @section Installation | |
429 @cindex installation | |
430 @cindex XEmacs | |
431 | |
432 @b{Important:} @i{If Org-mode is part of the Emacs distribution or an | |
433 XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly to | |
434 @ref{Activation}.} | |
435 | |
436 If you have downloaded Org-mode from the Web, you must take the | |
437 following steps to install it: Go into the Org-mode distribution | |
438 directory and edit the top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You | |
439 must set the name of the Emacs binary (likely either @file{emacs} or | |
440 @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the directories where local Lisp and | |
441 Info files are kept. If you don't have access to the system-wide | |
442 directories, create your own two directories for these files, enter them | |
443 into the Makefile, and make sure Emacs finds the Lisp files by adding | |
444 the following line to @file{.emacs}: | |
445 | |
446 @example | |
447 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/lispdir" load-path)) | |
448 @end example | |
449 | |
450 @b{XEmacs users now need to install the file @file{noutline.el} from | |
451 the @file{xemacs} subdirectory of the Org-mode distribution. Use the | |
452 command:} | |
453 | |
454 @example | |
455 @b{make install-noutline} | |
456 @end example | |
457 | |
458 @noindent Now byte-compile and install the Lisp files with the shell | |
459 commands: | |
460 | |
461 @example | |
462 make | |
463 make install | |
464 @end example | |
465 | |
466 @noindent If you want to install the info documentation, use this command: | |
467 | |
468 @example | |
469 make install-info | |
470 @end example | |
471 | |
472 @noindent Then add to @file{.emacs}: | |
473 | |
474 @lisp | |
475 ;; This line only if org-mode is not part of the X/Emacs distribution. | |
476 (require 'org-install) | |
477 @end lisp | |
478 | |
479 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction | |
480 @section Activation | |
481 @cindex activation | |
482 @cindex autoload | |
483 @cindex global keybindings | |
484 @cindex keybindings, global | |
485 | |
486 @iftex | |
487 @b{Important:} @i{If you use copy-and-paste to copy lisp code from the | |
488 PDF documentation as viewed by Acrobat reader to your .emacs file, the | |
489 single quote character comes out incorrectly and the code will not work. | |
490 You need to fix the single quotes by hand, or copy from Info | |
491 documentation.} | |
492 @end iftex | |
493 | |
494 Add the following lines to your @file{.emacs} file. The last two lines | |
495 define @emph{global} keys for the commands @command{org-store-link} and | |
496 @command{org-agenda} - please choose suitable keys yourself. | |
497 | |
498 @lisp | |
499 ;; The following lines are always needed. Choose your own keys. | |
500 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode)) | |
501 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link) | |
502 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda) | |
503 @end lisp | |
504 | |
505 Furthermore, you must activate @code{font-lock-mode} in org-mode | |
506 buffers, because significant functionality depends on font-locking being | |
507 active. You can do this with either one of the following two lines | |
508 (XEmacs user must use the second option): | |
509 @lisp | |
510 (global-font-lock-mode 1) ; for all buffers | |
511 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock) ; org-mode buffers only | |
512 @end lisp | |
513 | |
514 @cindex org-mode, turning on | |
515 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put | |
516 into Org-mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look | |
517 like this: | |
518 | |
519 @example | |
520 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*- | |
521 @end example | |
522 | |
523 @noindent which will select Org-mode for this buffer no matter what | |
524 the file's name is. See also the variable | |
525 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}. | |
526 | |
527 @node Feedback, , Activation, Introduction | |
528 @section Feedback | |
529 @cindex feedback | |
530 @cindex bug reports | |
531 @cindex maintainer | |
532 @cindex author | |
533 | |
534 If you find problems with Org-mode, or if you have questions, remarks, | |
535 or ideas about it, please contact the maintainer @value{MAINTAINER} at | |
536 @value{MAINTAINEREMAIL}. | |
537 | |
538 For bug reports, please provide as much information as possible, | |
539 including the version information of Emacs (@kbd{C-h v emacs-version | |
540 @key{RET}}) and Org-mode (@kbd{C-h v org-version @key{RET}}), as well as | |
541 the Org-mode related setup in @file{.emacs}. If an error occurs, a | |
542 backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to create one). Often a | |
543 small example file helps, along with clear information about: | |
544 | |
545 @enumerate | |
546 @item What exactly did you do? | |
547 @item What did you expect to happen? | |
548 @item What happened instead? | |
549 @end enumerate | |
550 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this mode. | |
551 | |
552 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace | |
553 | |
554 @cindex backtrace of an error | |
555 If working with Org-mode produces an error with a message you don't | |
556 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by | |
557 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{Backtrace}. | |
558 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the | |
559 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace: | |
560 | |
561 @enumerate | |
562 @item | |
563 Start a fresh Emacs or XEmacs, and make sure that it will load the | |
564 original Lisp code in @file{org.el} instead of the compiled version in | |
565 @file{org.elc}. The backtrace contains much more information if it is | |
566 produced with uncompiled code. To do this, either rename @file{org.elc} | |
567 to something else before starting Emacs, or ask Emacs explicitly to load | |
568 @file{org.el} by using the command line | |
569 @example | |
570 emacs -l /path/to/org.el | |
571 @end example | |
572 @item | |
573 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error} | |
574 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu). | |
575 @item | |
576 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to | |
577 document the steps you take. | |
578 @item | |
579 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the | |
580 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and | |
581 attach it to your bug report. | |
582 @end enumerate | |
583 | |
584 @node Document structure, Tables, Introduction, Top | |
585 @chapter Document Structure | |
586 @cindex document structure | |
587 @cindex structure of document | |
588 | |
589 Org-mode is based on outline mode and provides flexible commands to | |
590 edit the structure of the document. | |
591 | |
592 @menu | |
593 * Outlines:: Org-mode is based on outline-mode | |
594 * Headlines:: How to typeset org-tree headlines | |
595 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified | |
596 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines | |
597 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines | |
598 * Archiving:: Move done task trees to a different place | |
599 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context | |
600 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry | |
601 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away | |
602 * orgstruct-mode:: Structure editing outside Org-mode | |
603 @end menu | |
604 | |
605 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document structure, Document structure | |
606 @section Outlines | |
607 @cindex outlines | |
608 @cindex outline-mode | |
609 | |
610 Org-mode is implemented on top of outline-mode. Outlines allow a | |
611 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least | |
612 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview | |
613 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the | |
614 document to show only the general document structure and the parts | |
615 currently being worked on. Org-mode greatly simplifies the use of | |
616 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single | |
617 command @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key. | |
618 | |
619 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document structure | |
620 @section Headlines | |
621 @cindex headlines | |
622 @cindex outline tree | |
623 | |
624 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in | |
625 Org-mode start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See | |
626 the variable @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e} to configure special behavior | |
627 of @kbd{C-a} and @kbd{C-e} in headlines.}. For example: | |
628 | |
629 @example | |
630 * Top level headline | |
631 ** Second level | |
632 *** 3rd level | |
633 some text | |
634 *** 3rd level | |
635 more text | |
636 | |
637 * Another top level headline | |
638 @end example | |
639 | |
640 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an | |
641 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline | |
642 starters. @ref{Clean view} describes a setup to realize this. | |
643 | |
644 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and | |
645 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at | |
646 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding | |
647 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the | |
648 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior. | |
649 | |
650 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document structure | |
651 @section Visibility cycling | |
652 @cindex cycling, visibility | |
653 @cindex visibility cycling | |
654 @cindex trees, visibility | |
655 @cindex show hidden text | |
656 @cindex hide text | |
657 | |
658 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer. | |
659 Org-mode uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and | |
660 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer. | |
661 | |
662 @cindex subtree visibility states | |
663 @cindex subtree cycling | |
664 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state | |
665 @cindex children, subtree visibility state | |
666 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state | |
667 @table @kbd | |
668 @kindex @key{TAB} | |
669 @item @key{TAB} | |
670 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states | |
671 | |
672 @example | |
673 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --. | |
674 '-----------------------------------' | |
675 @end example | |
676 | |
677 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however, | |
678 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the | |
679 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then | |
680 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the | |
681 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix | |
682 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked. | |
683 | |
684 @cindex global visibility states | |
685 @cindex global cycling | |
686 @cindex overview, global visibility state | |
687 @cindex contents, global visibility state | |
688 @cindex show all, global visibility state | |
689 @kindex S-@key{TAB} | |
690 @item S-@key{TAB} | |
691 @itemx C-u @key{TAB} | |
692 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states | |
693 | |
694 @example | |
695 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --. | |
696 '--------------------------------------' | |
697 @end example | |
698 | |
699 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numerical prefix N, the CONTENTS | |
700 view up to headlines of level N will be shown. | |
701 Note that inside tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field. | |
702 | |
703 @cindex show all, command | |
704 @kindex C-c C-a | |
705 @item C-c C-a | |
706 Show all. | |
707 @kindex C-c C-r | |
708 @item C-c C-r | |
709 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following | |
710 heading and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location | |
711 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda | |
712 command (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With prefix arg show, on each | |
713 level, all sibling headings. | |
714 @kindex C-c C-x b | |
715 @item C-c C-x b | |
716 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect | |
717 buffer | |
718 @ifinfo | |
719 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual}) | |
720 @end ifinfo | |
721 @ifnotinfo | |
722 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers) | |
723 @end ifnotinfo | |
724 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current | |
725 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer, | |
726 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With numerical | |
727 prefix ARG, go up to this level and then take that tree. If ARG is | |
728 negative, go up that many levels. With @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove | |
729 the previously used indirect buffer. | |
730 @end table | |
731 | |
732 When Emacs first visits an Org-mode file, the global state is set to | |
733 OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be | |
734 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a | |
735 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the | |
736 buffer: | |
737 | |
738 @example | |
739 #+STARTUP: overview | |
740 #+STARTUP: content | |
741 #+STARTUP: showall | |
742 @end example | |
743 | |
744 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document structure | |
745 @section Motion | |
746 @cindex motion, between headlines | |
747 @cindex jumping, to headlines | |
748 @cindex headline navigation | |
749 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer. | |
750 | |
751 @table @kbd | |
752 @kindex C-c C-n | |
753 @item C-c C-n | |
754 Next heading. | |
755 @kindex C-c C-p | |
756 @item C-c C-p | |
757 Previous heading. | |
758 @kindex C-c C-f | |
759 @item C-c C-f | |
760 Next heading same level. | |
761 @kindex C-c C-b | |
762 @item C-c C-b | |
763 Previous heading same level. | |
764 @kindex C-c C-u | |
765 @item C-c C-u | |
766 Backward to higher level heading. | |
767 @kindex C-c C-j | |
768 @item C-c C-j | |
769 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline | |
770 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where | |
771 you can use the following keys to find your destination: | |
772 @example | |
773 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.} | |
774 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.} | |
775 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.} | |
776 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.} | |
777 u @r{One level up.} | |
778 0-9 @r{Digit argument.} | |
779 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.} | |
780 @end example | |
781 @end table | |
782 | |
783 @node Structure editing, Archiving, Motion, Document structure | |
784 @section Structure editing | |
785 @cindex structure editing | |
786 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion | |
787 @cindex promotion, of subtrees | |
788 @cindex demotion, of subtrees | |
789 @cindex subtree, cut and paste | |
790 @cindex pasting, of subtrees | |
791 @cindex cutting, of subtrees | |
792 @cindex copying, of subtrees | |
793 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste | |
794 | |
795 @table @kbd | |
796 @kindex M-@key{RET} | |
797 @item M-@key{RET} | |
798 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a | |
799 plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force | |
800 creation of a new headline, use a prefix arg, or first press @key{RET} | |
801 to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in | |
802 the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes | |
803 the new headline. If the command is used at the beginning of a | |
804 headline, the new headline is created before the current line. If at | |
805 the beginning of any other line, the content of that line is made the | |
806 new heading. If the command is used at the end of a folded subtree | |
807 (i.e. behind the ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline | |
808 like the current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree. | |
809 @kindex M-S-@key{RET} | |
810 @item M-S-@key{RET} | |
811 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. | |
812 @kindex M-@key{left} | |
813 @item M-@key{left} | |
814 Promote current heading by one level. | |
815 @kindex M-@key{right} | |
816 @item M-@key{right} | |
817 Demote current heading by one level. | |
818 @kindex M-S-@key{left} | |
819 @item M-S-@key{left} | |
820 Promote the current subtree by one level. | |
821 @kindex M-S-@key{right} | |
822 @item M-S-@key{right} | |
823 Demote the current subtree by one level. | |
824 @kindex M-S-@key{up} | |
825 @item M-S-@key{up} | |
826 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same | |
827 level). | |
828 @kindex M-S-@key{down} | |
829 @item M-S-@key{down} | |
830 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level). | |
831 @kindex C-c C-x C-w | |
832 @kindex C-c C-x C-k | |
833 @item C-c C-x C-w | |
834 @itemx C-c C-x C-k | |
835 Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring. | |
836 @kindex C-c C-x M-w | |
837 @item C-c C-x M-w | |
838 Copy subtree to kill ring. | |
839 @kindex C-c C-x C-y | |
840 @item C-c C-x C-y | |
841 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to | |
842 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank | |
843 level can also be specified with a prefix arg, or by yanking after a | |
844 headline marker like @samp{****}. | |
845 @kindex C-c ^ | |
846 @item C-c ^ | |
847 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in | |
848 the region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current | |
849 headline are sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which | |
850 can be alphabetically, numerically, by time (using the first time stamp | |
851 in each entry), by priority, and each of these in reverse order. With a | |
852 @kbd{C-u} prefix, sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u | |
853 C-u} prefixes, duplicate entries will also be removed. | |
854 @end table | |
855 | |
856 @cindex region, active | |
857 @cindex active region | |
858 @cindex transient-mark-mode | |
859 When there is an active region (transient-mark-mode), promotion and | |
860 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of | |
861 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a | |
862 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line | |
863 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is | |
864 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different | |
865 functionality. | |
866 | |
867 @node Archiving, Sparse trees, Structure editing, Document structure | |
868 @section Archiving | |
869 @cindex archiving | |
870 | |
871 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want | |
872 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the | |
873 agenda. Org-mode knows two ways of archiving. You can mark a tree with | |
874 the ARCHIVE tag, or you can move an entire (sub)tree to a different | |
875 location. | |
876 | |
877 @menu | |
878 * ARCHIVE tag:: Marking a tree as inactive | |
879 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file | |
880 @end menu | |
881 | |
882 @node ARCHIVE tag, Moving subtrees, Archiving, Archiving | |
883 @subsection The ARCHIVE tag | |
884 @cindex internal archiving | |
885 | |
886 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at | |
887 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way: | |
888 @itemize @minus | |
889 @item | |
890 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling | |
891 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived | |
892 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option | |
893 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like | |
894 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees. | |
895 @item | |
896 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in | |
897 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option | |
898 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}. | |
899 @item | |
900 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda views}), the content of | |
901 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option | |
902 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}. | |
903 @item | |
904 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline | |
905 is. Configure the details using the variable | |
906 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}. | |
907 @end itemize | |
908 | |
909 The following commands help managing the ARCHIVE tag: | |
910 | |
911 @table @kbd | |
912 @kindex C-c C-x C-a | |
913 @item C-c C-x C-a | |
914 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set, | |
915 the headline changes to a shadowish face, and the subtree below it is | |
916 hidden. | |
917 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-a | |
918 @item C-u C-c C-x C-a | |
919 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived. | |
920 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are | |
921 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the | |
922 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the | |
923 level 1 trees will be checked. | |
924 @kindex C-@kbd{TAB} | |
925 @item C-@kbd{TAB} | |
926 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE. | |
927 @end table | |
928 | |
929 @node Moving subtrees, , ARCHIVE tag, Archiving | |
930 @subsection Moving subtrees | |
931 @cindex external archiving | |
932 | |
933 Once an entire project is finished, you may want to move it to a | |
934 different location, either in the current file, or even in a different | |
935 file, the archive file. | |
936 | |
937 @table @kbd | |
938 @kindex C-c C-x C-s | |
939 @item C-c C-x C-s | |
940 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location | |
941 given by @code{org-archive-location}. Context information that could be | |
942 lost like the file name, the category, inherited tags, and the todo | |
943 state will be store as properties in the entry. | |
944 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-s | |
945 @item C-u C-c C-x C-s | |
946 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to | |
947 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. | |
948 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive | |
949 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command | |
950 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked. | |
951 @end table | |
952 | |
953 @cindex archive locations | |
954 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the | |
955 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the | |
956 current file name. For information and examples on how to change this, | |
957 see the documentation string of the variable | |
958 @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for | |
959 setting this variable, for example | |
960 | |
961 @example | |
962 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done:: | |
963 @end example | |
964 | |
965 @noindent | |
966 You may have several such lines in the buffer, they will then be valid | |
967 for the entries following the line (the first will also apply to any | |
968 text before it). | |
969 | |
970 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Archiving, Document structure | |
971 @section Sparse trees | |
972 @cindex sparse trees | |
973 @cindex trees, sparse | |
974 @cindex folding, sparse trees | |
975 @cindex occur, command | |
976 | |
977 An important feature of Org-mode is the ability to construct | |
978 @emph{sparse trees} for selected information in an outline tree. A | |
979 sparse tree means that the entire document is folded as much as | |
980 possible, but the selected information is made visible along with the | |
981 headline structure above it@footnote{See also the variables | |
982 @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading}, and | |
983 @code{org-show-siblings} for detailed control on how much context is | |
984 shown around each match.}. Just try it out and you will see immediately | |
985 how it works. | |
986 | |
987 Org-mode contains several commands creating such trees. The most | |
988 basic one is @command{org-occur}: | |
989 | |
990 @table @kbd | |
991 @kindex C-c / | |
992 @item C-c / | |
993 Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. | |
994 If the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the | |
995 match is in the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. | |
996 In order to provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of | |
997 headlines above the match is shown, as well as the headline following | |
998 the match. Each match is also highlighted; the highlights disappear | |
999 when the buffer is changed by an editing command, or by pressing | |
1000 @kbd{C-c C-c}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous | |
1001 highlights are kept, so several calls to this command can be stacked. | |
1002 @end table | |
1003 @noindent | |
1004 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can | |
1005 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast | |
1006 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be | |
1007 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). | |
1008 For example: | |
1009 | |
1010 @lisp | |
1011 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands | |
1012 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME"))) | |
1013 @end lisp | |
1014 | |
1015 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating | |
1016 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}. | |
1017 | |
1018 Other commands use sparse trees as well. For example @kbd{C-c | |
1019 C-v} creates a sparse TODO tree (@pxref{TODO basics}). | |
1020 | |
1021 @kindex C-c C-e v | |
1022 @cindex printing sparse trees | |
1023 @cindex visible text, printing | |
1024 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command | |
1025 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts | |
1026 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because | |
1027 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}. | |
1028 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible | |
1029 part of the document and print the resulting file. | |
1030 | |
1031 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document structure | |
1032 @section Plain lists | |
1033 @cindex plain lists | |
1034 @cindex lists, plain | |
1035 @cindex lists, ordered | |
1036 @cindex ordered lists | |
1037 | |
1038 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide | |
1039 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of | |
1040 checkboxes (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org-mode supports editing such lists, | |
1041 and the HTML exporter (@pxref{Exporting}) does parse and format them. | |
1042 | |
1043 Org-mode knows ordered and unordered lists. Unordered list items start | |
1044 with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a | |
1045 bullet, lines must be indented or they will be seen as top-level | |
1046 headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading stars to get a clean | |
1047 outline view, plain list items starting with a star are visually | |
1048 indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*} | |
1049 is supported, it may be better not to use it for plain list items.} as | |
1050 bullets. Ordered list items start with @samp{1.} or @samp{1)}. Items | |
1051 belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first | |
1052 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then | |
1053 the 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers | |
1054 in the list. Indentation also determines the end of a list item. It | |
1055 ends before the next line that is indented like the bullet/number, or | |
1056 less. Empty lines are part of the previous item, so you can have | |
1057 several paragraphs in one item. If you would like an empty line to | |
1058 terminate all currently open plain lists, configure the variable | |
1059 @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}. Here is an example: | |
1060 | |
1061 @example | |
1062 @group | |
1063 ** Lord of the Rings | |
1064 My favorite scenes are (in this order) | |
1065 1. The attack of the Rohirrim | |
1066 2. Eowyns fight with the witch king | |
1067 + this was already my favorite scene in the book | |
1068 + I really like Miranda Otto. | |
1069 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas | |
1070 - on DVD only | |
1071 He makes a really funny face when it happens. | |
1072 But in the end, not individual scenes matter but the film as a whole. | |
1073 @end group | |
1074 @end example | |
1075 | |
1076 Org-mode supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to | |
1077 deal with them correctly@footnote{Org-mode only changes the filling | |
1078 settings for Emacs. For XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' | |
1079 @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on, put into @file{.emacs}: | |
1080 @code{(require 'filladapt)}}. | |
1081 | |
1082 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line | |
1083 of an item (the line with the bullet or number). | |
1084 | |
1085 @table @kbd | |
1086 @kindex @key{TAB} | |
1087 @item @key{TAB} | |
1088 Items can be folded just like headline levels if you set the variable | |
1089 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. The level of an item is then | |
1090 given by the indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always | |
1091 subordinate to real headlines, however; the hierarchies remain | |
1092 completely separated. | |
1093 | |
1094 If @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists} has not been set, @key{TAB} | |
1095 fixes the indentation of the curent line in a heuristic way. | |
1096 @kindex M-@key{RET} | |
1097 @item M-@key{RET} | |
1098 Insert new item at current level. With prefix arg, force a new heading | |
1099 (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle of a | |
1100 line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new | |
1101 item. If this command is executed in the @emph{whitespace before a bullet or | |
1102 number}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current item. If the | |
1103 command is executed in the white space before the text that is part of | |
1104 an item but does not contain the bullet, a bullet is added to the | |
1105 current line. | |
1106 @kindex M-S-@key{RET} | |
1107 @item M-S-@key{RET} | |
1108 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}). | |
1109 @kindex S-@key{up} | |
1110 @kindex S-@key{down} | |
1111 @item S-@key{up} | |
1112 @itemx S-@key{down} | |
1113 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list. | |
1114 @kindex M-S-@key{up} | |
1115 @kindex M-S-@key{down} | |
1116 @item M-S-@key{up} | |
1117 @itemx M-S-@key{down} | |
1118 Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item | |
1119 of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is | |
1120 automatic. | |
1121 @kindex M-S-@key{left} | |
1122 @kindex M-S-@key{right} | |
1123 @item M-S-@key{left} | |
1124 @itemx M-S-@key{right} | |
1125 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems. | |
1126 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. | |
1127 When these commands are executed several times in direct succession, | |
1128 the initially selected region is used, even if the new indentation | |
1129 would imply a different hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break | |
1130 the command chain with a cursor motion or so. | |
1131 @kindex C-c C-c | |
1132 @item C-c C-c | |
1133 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the | |
1134 state of the checkbox. If not, make this command makes sure that all | |
1135 the items on this list level use the same bullet. Furthermore, if this | |
1136 is an ordered list, make sure the numbering is ok. | |
1137 @kindex C-c - | |
1138 @item C-c - | |
1139 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate | |
1140 bullets (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}). | |
1141 With prefix arg, select the nth bullet from this list. | |
1142 @end table | |
1143 | |
1144 @node Drawers, orgstruct-mode, Plain lists, Document structure | |
1145 @section Drawers | |
1146 @cindex drawers | |
1147 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers | |
1148 | |
1149 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you | |
1150 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org-mode has @emph{drawers}. | |
1151 Drawers need to be configured with the variable @code{org-drawers}, and | |
1152 look like this: | |
1153 | |
1154 @example | |
1155 ** This is a headline | |
1156 Still outside the drawer | |
1157 :DRAWERNAME: | |
1158 This is inside the drawer. | |
1159 :END: | |
1160 After the drawer. | |
1161 @end example | |
1162 | |
1163 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will | |
1164 hide and show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. | |
1165 In order to look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the | |
1166 drawer line and press @key{TAB} there. Org-mode uses a drawer for | |
1167 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and columns}). | |
1168 | |
1169 @node orgstruct-mode, , Drawers, Document structure | |
1170 @section The Orgstruct minor mode | |
1171 @cindex orgstruct-mode | |
1172 @cindex minor mode for structure editing | |
1173 | |
1174 If you like the intuitive way the Org-mode structure editing and list | |
1175 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes | |
1176 like text-mode or mail-mode as well. The minor mode Orgstruct-mode | |
1177 makes this possible. You can always toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x | |
1178 orgstruct-mode}. To turn it on by default, for example in mail mode, | |
1179 use | |
1180 | |
1181 @lisp | |
1182 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct) | |
1183 @end lisp | |
1184 | |
1185 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to | |
1186 Org-mode like a headline of the first line of a list item, most | |
1187 structure editing commands will work, even if the same keys normally | |
1188 have different functionality in the major mode you are using. If the | |
1189 cursor is not in one of those special lines, Orgstruct-mode lurks | |
1190 silently in the shadow. | |
1191 | |
1192 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document structure, Top | |
1193 @chapter Tables | |
1194 @cindex tables | |
1195 @cindex editing tables | |
1196 | |
1197 Org-mode has a very fast and intuitive table editor built-in. | |
1198 Spreadsheet-like calculations are supported in connection with the | |
1199 Emacs @file{calc} package. | |
1200 | |
1201 @menu | |
1202 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables | |
1203 * Narrow columns:: Stop wasting space in tables | |
1204 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines | |
1205 * orgtbl-mode:: The table editor as minor mode | |
1206 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities. | |
1207 @end menu | |
1208 | |
1209 @node Built-in table editor, Narrow columns, Tables, Tables | |
1210 @section The built-in table editor | |
1211 @cindex table editor, built-in | |
1212 | |
1213 Org-mode makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with | |
1214 @samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a | |
1215 table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like | |
1216 this: | |
1217 | |
1218 @example | |
1219 | Name | Phone | Age | | |
1220 |-------+-------+-----| | |
1221 | Peter | 1234 | 17 | | |
1222 | Anna | 4321 | 25 | | |
1223 @end example | |
1224 | |
1225 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or | |
1226 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to | |
1227 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows | |
1228 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation | |
1229 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with | |
1230 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be | |
1231 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to | |
1232 create the above table, you would only type | |
1233 | |
1234 @example | |
1235 |Name|Phone|Age| | |
1236 |- | |
1237 @end example | |
1238 | |
1239 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in | |
1240 fields. | |
1241 | |
1242 When typing text into a field, Org-mode treats @key{DEL}, | |
1243 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that | |
1244 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when | |
1245 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field | |
1246 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the | |
1247 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too | |
1248 unpredictable for you, configure the variables | |
1249 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}. | |
1250 | |
1251 @table @kbd | |
1252 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion} | |
1253 @kindex C-c | | |
1254 @item C-c | | |
1255 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one | |
1256 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated. | |
1257 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix | |
1258 argument to indicate the minimum number of consecutive spaces required | |
1259 to identify a field separator (default: just one).@* | |
1260 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org-mode | |
1261 table. But it's easier just to start typing, like | |
1262 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}. | |
1263 | |
1264 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion} | |
1265 @kindex C-c C-c | |
1266 @item C-c C-c | |
1267 Re-align the table without moving the cursor. | |
1268 @c | |
1269 @kindex @key{TAB} | |
1270 @item @key{TAB} | |
1271 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if | |
1272 necessary. | |
1273 @c | |
1274 @kindex S-@key{TAB} | |
1275 @item S-@key{TAB} | |
1276 Re-align, move to previous field. | |
1277 @c | |
1278 @kindex @key{RET} | |
1279 @item @key{RET} | |
1280 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if | |
1281 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does | |
1282 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table. | |
1283 | |
1284 @tsubheading{Column and row editing} | |
1285 @kindex M-@key{left} | |
1286 @kindex M-@key{right} | |
1287 @item M-@key{left} | |
1288 @itemx M-@key{right} | |
1289 Move the current column left/right. | |
1290 @c | |
1291 @kindex M-S-@key{left} | |
1292 @item M-S-@key{left} | |
1293 Kill the current column. | |
1294 @c | |
1295 @kindex M-S-@key{right} | |
1296 @item M-S-@key{right} | |
1297 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position. | |
1298 @c | |
1299 @kindex M-@key{up} | |
1300 @kindex M-@key{down} | |
1301 @item M-@key{up} | |
1302 @itemx M-@key{down} | |
1303 Move the current row up/down. | |
1304 @c | |
1305 @kindex M-S-@key{up} | |
1306 @item M-S-@key{up} | |
1307 Kill the current row or horizontal line. | |
1308 @c | |
1309 @kindex M-S-@key{down} | |
1310 @item M-S-@key{down} | |
1311 Insert a new row above (with arg: below) the current row. | |
1312 @c | |
1313 @kindex C-c - | |
1314 @item C-c - | |
1315 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With prefix arg, the line | |
1316 is created above the current line. | |
1317 @c | |
1318 @kindex C-c ^ | |
1319 @item C-c ^ | |
1320 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the | |
1321 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range | |
1322 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If | |
1323 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting | |
1324 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line | |
1325 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be | |
1326 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type | |
1327 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix | |
1328 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive. | |
1329 | |
1330 @tsubheading{Regions} | |
1331 @kindex C-c C-x M-w | |
1332 @item C-c C-x M-w | |
1333 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point | |
1334 and mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. The process ignores | |
1335 horizontal separator lines. | |
1336 @c | |
1337 @kindex C-c C-x C-w | |
1338 @item C-c C-x C-w | |
1339 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and | |
1340 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation. | |
1341 @c | |
1342 @kindex C-c C-x C-y | |
1343 @item C-c C-x C-y | |
1344 Paste a rectangular region into a table. | |
1345 The upper right corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields | |
1346 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table, | |
1347 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator | |
1348 lines. | |
1349 @c | |
1350 @kindex C-c C-q | |
1351 @item C-c C-q | |
1352 Wrap several fields in a column like a paragraph. If there is an active | |
1353 region, and both point and mark are in the same column, the text in the | |
1354 column is wrapped to minimum width for the given number of lines. A | |
1355 prefix ARG may be used to change the number of desired lines. If there | |
1356 is no region, the current field is split at the cursor position and the | |
1357 text fragment to the right of the cursor is prepended to the field one | |
1358 line down. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix ARG, the | |
1359 current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field | |
1360 above. | |
1361 | |
1362 @tsubheading{Calculations} | |
1363 @cindex formula, in tables | |
1364 @cindex calculations, in tables | |
1365 @cindex region, active | |
1366 @cindex active region | |
1367 @cindex transient-mark-mode | |
1368 @kindex C-c + | |
1369 @item C-c + | |
1370 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by | |
1371 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can | |
1372 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}. | |
1373 @c | |
1374 @kindex S-@key{RET} | |
1375 @item S-@key{RET} | |
1376 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. | |
1377 When not empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor | |
1378 along with it. Depending on the variable | |
1379 @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field values will be | |
1380 incremented during copy. This key is also used by CUA-mode | |
1381 (@pxref{Cooperation}). | |
1382 | |
1383 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous} | |
1384 @kindex C-c ` | |
1385 @item C-c ` | |
1386 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields | |
1387 that are not fully visible (@pxref{Narrow columns}). When called with a | |
1388 @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be | |
1389 edited in place. | |
1390 @c | |
1391 @kindex C-c @key{TAB} | |
1392 @item C-c @key{TAB} | |
1393 This is an alias for @kbd{C-u C-c `} to make the current field fully | |
1394 visible. | |
1395 @c | |
1396 @item M-x org-table-import | |
1397 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB- or whitespace | |
1398 separated. Useful, for example, to import an Excel table or data from a | |
1399 database, because these programs generally can write TAB-separated text | |
1400 files. This command works by inserting the file into the buffer and | |
1401 then converting the region to a table. Any prefix argument is passed on | |
1402 to the converter, which uses it to determine the separator. | |
1403 @item C-c | | |
1404 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the org-mode | |
1405 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the | |
1406 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}. | |
1407 @c | |
1408 @item M-x org-table-export | |
1409 Export the table as a TAB-separated file. Useful for data exchange with, | |
1410 for example, Excel or database programs. | |
1411 @end table | |
1412 | |
1413 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your | |
1414 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn | |
1415 it off with | |
1416 | |
1417 @lisp | |
1418 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil) | |
1419 @end lisp | |
1420 | |
1421 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is | |
1422 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align. | |
1423 | |
1424 @node Narrow columns, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables | |
1425 @section Narrow columns | |
1426 @cindex narrow columns in tables | |
1427 | |
1428 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. | |
1429 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, | |
1430 leading to inconveniently wide columns. To limit@footnote{This feature | |
1431 does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere in | |
1432 the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an | |
1433 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next | |
1434 re-align will then set the width of this column to no more than this | |
1435 value. | |
1436 | |
1437 @example | |
1438 @group | |
1439 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------| | |
1440 | | | | | <6> | | |
1441 | 1 | one | | 1 | one | | |
1442 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two | | |
1443 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> | | |
1444 | 4 | four | | 4 | four | | |
1445 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------| | |
1446 @end group | |
1447 @end example | |
1448 | |
1449 @noindent | |
1450 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}. | |
1451 Note that the full text is still in the buffer, it is only invisible. | |
1452 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field - a tool-tip window | |
1453 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command | |
1454 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will | |
1455 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c | |
1456 C-c}. | |
1457 | |
1458 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the | |
1459 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to | |
1460 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option | |
1461 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file | |
1462 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option | |
1463 on a per-file basis with: | |
1464 | |
1465 @example | |
1466 #+STARTUP: align | |
1467 #+STARTUP: noalign | |
1468 @end example | |
1469 | |
1470 @node Column groups, orgtbl-mode, Narrow columns, Tables | |
1471 @section Column groups | |
1472 @cindex grouping columns in tables | |
1473 | |
1474 When Org-mode exports tables, it does so by default without vertical | |
1475 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally | |
1476 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups | |
1477 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In | |
1478 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the | |
1479 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either | |
1480 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group, | |
1481 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column | |
1482 a group of its own. Boundaries between colum groups will upon export be | |
1483 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example: | |
1484 | |
1485 @example | |
1486 | | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) | | |
1487 |---+----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------| | |
1488 | / | <> | < | | > | < | > | | |
1489 | # | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | | |
1490 | # | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 | | |
1491 | # | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 | | |
1492 |---+----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------| | |
1493 #+TBLFM: $3=$2^2::$4=$2^3::$5=$2^4::$6=sqrt($2)::$7=sqrt(sqrt(($2)) | |
1494 @end example | |
1495 | |
1496 It is also sufficient to just insert the colum group starters after | |
1497 every vertical line you'd like to have: | |
1498 | |
1499 @example | |
1500 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) | | |
1501 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------| | |
1502 | / | < | | | < | | | |
1503 @end example | |
1504 | |
1505 @node orgtbl-mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables | |
1506 @section The Orgtbl minor mode | |
1507 @cindex orgtbl-mode | |
1508 @cindex minor mode for tables | |
1509 | |
1510 If you like the intuitive way the Org-mode table editor works, you | |
1511 might also want to use it in other modes like text-mode or mail-mode. | |
1512 The minor mode Orgtbl-mode makes this possible. You can always toggle | |
1513 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for | |
1514 example in mail mode, use | |
1515 | |
1516 @lisp | |
1517 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl) | |
1518 @end lisp | |
1519 | |
1520 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables | |
1521 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl-mode. For example, it is possible to | |
1522 construct La@TeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of | |
1523 Orgtbl-mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see | |
1524 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}. | |
1525 | |
1526 @node The spreadsheet, , orgtbl-mode, Tables | |
1527 @section The spreadsheet | |
1528 @cindex calculations, in tables | |
1529 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities | |
1530 @cindex @file{calc} package | |
1531 | |
1532 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement | |
1533 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to | |
1534 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org-mode's | |
1535 implementation is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, | |
1536 Org-mode knows the concept of a @emph{column formula} that will be | |
1537 applied to all non-header fields in a column without having to copy the | |
1538 formula to each relevant field. | |
1539 | |
1540 @menu | |
1541 * References:: How to refer to another field or range | |
1542 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff | |
1543 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp | |
1544 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field | |
1545 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column | |
1546 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas | |
1547 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields | |
1548 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc | |
1549 @end menu | |
1550 | |
1551 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet | |
1552 @subsection References | |
1553 @cindex references | |
1554 | |
1555 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must | |
1556 reference other fields or ranges. In Org-mode, fields can be referenced | |
1557 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find | |
1558 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that | |
1559 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid. | |
1560 | |
1561 @subsubheading Field references | |
1562 @cindex field references | |
1563 @cindex references, to fields | |
1564 | |
1565 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in | |
1566 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number | |
1567 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row. | |
1568 @c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change | |
1569 @c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So | |
1570 @c Org-mode's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets. | |
1571 | |
1572 @noindent | |
1573 Org-mode also uses another, more general operator that looks like this: | |
1574 @example | |
1575 @@row$column | |
1576 @end example | |
1577 | |
1578 @noindent | |
1579 Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{N}, | |
1580 or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}. | |
1581 | |
1582 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal | |
1583 separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers | |
1584 @samp{1}...@samp{N}, and row numbers relative to the current row like | |
1585 @samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the | |
1586 hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline, @samp{II} to the second etc. | |
1587 @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the current line, | |
1588 @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line. You can also | |
1589 write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the third hline | |
1590 in the table. Relative row numbers like @samp{-3} will not cross hlines | |
1591 if the current line is too close to the hline. Instead, the value | |
1592 directly at the hline is used. | |
1593 | |
1594 @samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit | |
1595 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current | |
1596 row/column is implied. | |
1597 | |
1598 Org-mode's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references | |
1599 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two | |
1600 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time. | |
1601 Org-mode's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating | |
1602 references because the same reference operator can reference different | |
1603 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula. | |
1604 | |
1605 Here are a few examples: | |
1606 | |
1607 @example | |
1608 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column} | |
1609 C2 @r{same as previous} | |
1610 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row} | |
1611 E& @r{same as previous} | |
1612 @@2 @r{current column, row 2} | |
1613 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left} | |
1614 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2} | |
1615 @end example | |
1616 | |
1617 @subsubheading Range references | |
1618 @cindex range references | |
1619 @cindex references, to ranges | |
1620 | |
1621 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field | |
1622 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the | |
1623 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field | |
1624 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column} | |
1625 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with | |
1626 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples: | |
1627 | |
1628 @example | |
1629 $1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.} | |
1630 $P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)} | |
1631 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.} | |
1632 A2..C4 @r{Same as above.} | |
1633 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row} | |
1634 @end example | |
1635 | |
1636 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed | |
1637 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally | |
1638 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but | |
1639 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields, | |
1640 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas. | |
1641 | |
1642 @subsubheading Named references | |
1643 @cindex named references | |
1644 @cindex references, named | |
1645 @cindex name, of column or field | |
1646 @cindex constants, in calculations | |
1647 | |
1648 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or | |
1649 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable | |
1650 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a | |
1651 line like | |
1652 | |
1653 @example | |
1654 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6 | |
1655 @end example | |
1656 | |
1657 @noindent | |
1658 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and columns}) can be used as | |
1659 constants in table formulas: For a property @samp{:XYZ:} use the name | |
1660 @samp{$PROP_XYZ}, and the property will be searched in the current | |
1661 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the | |
1662 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants, | |
1663 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and | |
1664 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{Constant.el} can | |
1665 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI} | |
1666 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable | |
1667 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options | |
1668 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current | |
1669 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table | |
1670 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All | |
1671 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and | |
1672 numbers. | |
1673 | |
1674 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet | |
1675 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc | |
1676 @cindex formula syntax, Calc | |
1677 @cindex syntax, of formulas | |
1678 | |
1679 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs | |
1680 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the | |
1681 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than | |
1682 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before | |
1683 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from | |
1684 Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling calc from Your Lisp Programs,calc,GNU | |
1685 Emacs Calc Manual}), | |
1686 @c FIXME: The link to the calc manual in HTML does not work. | |
1687 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above. | |
1688 @cindex vectors, in table calculations | |
1689 The range vectors can be directly fed into the calc vector functions | |
1690 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}. | |
1691 | |
1692 @cindex format specifier | |
1693 @cindex mode, for @file{calc} | |
1694 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This | |
1695 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during | |
1696 execution. By default, Org-mode uses the standard calc modes (precision | |
1697 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off. The display | |
1698 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 5)} to keep tables | |
1699 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable | |
1700 @code{org-calc-default-modes}. | |
1701 | |
1702 @example | |
1703 p20 @r{switch the internal precision to 20 digits} | |
1704 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed display format} | |
1705 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians} | |
1706 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes} | |
1707 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers} | |
1708 T @r{force text interpretation} | |
1709 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges} | |
1710 @end example | |
1711 | |
1712 @noindent | |
1713 In addition, you may provide a @code{printf} format specifier to | |
1714 reformat the final result. A few examples: | |
1715 | |
1716 @example | |
1717 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field} | |
1718 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals} | |
1719 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used} | |
1720 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal} | |
1721 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion} | |
1722 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}} | |
1723 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1} | |
1724 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display} | |
1725 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function} | |
1726 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0} | |
1727 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree} | |
1728 @end example | |
1729 | |
1730 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example | |
1731 | |
1732 @example | |
1733 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty} | |
1734 @end example | |
1735 | |
1736 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet | |
1737 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas | |
1738 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas | |
1739 | |
1740 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful | |
1741 for string manipulation and control structures, if the Calc's | |
1742 functionality is not enough. If a formula starts with a single quote | |
1743 followed by an opening parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a lisp form. | |
1744 The evaluation should return either a string or a number. Just as with | |
1745 @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes and a printf format after a | |
1746 semicolon. With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be concious about the way | |
1747 field references are interpolated into the form. By default, a | |
1748 reference will be interpolated as a Lisp string (in double quotes) | |
1749 containing the field. If you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all | |
1750 referenced elements will be numbers (non-number fields will be zero) and | |
1751 interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you provide the | |
1752 @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally, without quotes. | |
1753 I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp | |
1754 form, enclode the reference operator itself in double quotes, like | |
1755 @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can | |
1756 embed them in list or vector syntax. A few examples, note how the | |
1757 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in lisp. | |
1758 | |
1759 @example | |
1760 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1} | |
1761 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2)) | |
1762 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to the Calc's @code{$1+$2}} | |
1763 '(+ $1 $2);N | |
1764 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}} | |
1765 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N | |
1766 @end example | |
1767 | |
1768 @node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet | |
1769 @subsection Field formulas | |
1770 @cindex field formula | |
1771 @cindex formula, for individual table field | |
1772 | |
1773 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the | |
1774 field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you | |
1775 press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in | |
1776 the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, | |
1777 evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result. | |
1778 | |
1779 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} | |
1780 directly below the table. If you typed the equation in the 4th field of | |
1781 the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like | |
1782 @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows | |
1783 with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative | |
1784 ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the | |
1785 same field. Of cause this is not true if you edit the table structure | |
1786 with normal editing commands - then you must fix the equations yourself. | |
1787 | |
1788 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the | |
1789 following command | |
1790 | |
1791 @table @kbd | |
1792 @kindex C-u C-c = | |
1793 @item C-u C-c = | |
1794 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a | |
1795 formula, with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies | |
1796 it to the current field and stores it. | |
1797 @end table | |
1798 | |
1799 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet | |
1800 @subsection Column formulas | |
1801 @cindex column formula | |
1802 @cindex formula, for table column | |
1803 | |
1804 Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a | |
1805 particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields | |
1806 in that column, org-mode allows to assign a single formula to an entire | |
1807 column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything | |
1808 before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header} | |
1809 and will not be modified by column formulas. | |
1810 | |
1811 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the | |
1812 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press | |
1813 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the | |
1814 field, the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, | |
1815 evaluated and the current field replaced with the result. If the field | |
1816 contains only @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is | |
1817 used. For each column, Org-mode will only remember the most recently | |
1818 used formula. In the @samp{TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like | |
1819 @samp{$4=$1+$2}. | |
1820 | |
1821 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the | |
1822 following command: | |
1823 | |
1824 @table @kbd | |
1825 @kindex C-c = | |
1826 @item C-c = | |
1827 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field | |
1828 with the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with | |
1829 default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current | |
1830 field and stores it. With a numerical prefix (e.g. @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) | |
1831 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column. | |
1832 @end table | |
1833 | |
1834 | |
1835 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet | |
1836 @subsection Editing and Debugging formulas | |
1837 @cindex formula editing | |
1838 @cindex editing, of table formulas | |
1839 | |
1840 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the | |
1841 field. Org-mode can also prepare a special buffer with all active | |
1842 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org-mode | |
1843 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&}) | |
1844 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like | |
1845 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable | |
1846 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}. | |
1847 | |
1848 @table @kbd | |
1849 @kindex C-c = | |
1850 @kindex C-u C-c = | |
1851 @item C-c = | |
1852 @itemx C-u C-c = | |
1853 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the | |
1854 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas} and @ref{Field formulas}. | |
1855 @kindex C-u C-u C-c = | |
1856 @item C-u C-u C-c = | |
1857 Re-insert the active formula (either a | |
1858 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you | |
1859 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the | |
1860 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}. | |
1861 @kindex C-c ? | |
1862 @item C-c ? | |
1863 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s) | |
1864 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula. | |
1865 @kindex C-c @} | |
1866 @item C-c @} | |
1867 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using | |
1868 overlays. These are updated each time the table is aligned, you can | |
1869 force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}. | |
1870 @kindex C-c @{ | |
1871 @item C-c @{ | |
1872 Toggle the formula debugger on and off. See below. | |
1873 @kindex C-c ' | |
1874 @item C-c ' | |
1875 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the | |
1876 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an | |
1877 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it. | |
1878 While inside the special buffer, Org-mode will automatically highlight | |
1879 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit, | |
1880 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands: | |
1881 @table @kbd | |
1882 @kindex C-c C-c | |
1883 @kindex C-x C-s | |
1884 @item C-c C-c | |
1885 @itemx C-x C-s | |
1886 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u} | |
1887 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table. | |
1888 @kindex C-c C-q | |
1889 @item C-c C-q | |
1890 Exit the formula editor without installing changes. | |
1891 @kindex C-c C-r | |
1892 @item C-c C-r | |
1893 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like | |
1894 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}). | |
1895 @kindex @key{TAB} | |
1896 @item @key{TAB} | |
1897 Pretty-print or indent lisp formula at point. When in a line containing | |
1898 a lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules. | |
1899 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open | |
1900 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs-lisp-mode. | |
1901 @kindex M-@key{TAB} | |
1902 @item M-@key{TAB} | |
1903 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs-lisp-mode. | |
1904 @kindex S-@key{up} | |
1905 @kindex S-@key{down} | |
1906 @kindex S-@key{left} | |
1907 @kindex S-@key{right} | |
1908 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right} | |
1909 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is | |
1910 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}. | |
1911 This also works for relative references, and for hline references. | |
1912 @kindex M-S-@key{up} | |
1913 @kindex M-S-@key{down} | |
1914 @item M-S-@key{up}/@key{down} | |
1915 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org-mode buffer up and | |
1916 down. | |
1917 @kindex M-@key{up} | |
1918 @kindex M-@key{down} | |
1919 @item M-@key{up}/@key{down} | |
1920 Scroll the window displaying the table. | |
1921 @kindex C-c @} | |
1922 @item C-c @} | |
1923 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off. | |
1924 @end table | |
1925 @end table | |
1926 | |
1927 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with | |
1928 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{TBLFM} | |
1929 line) - during the next recalculation the field will be filled again. | |
1930 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when | |
1931 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line. | |
1932 | |
1933 @kindex C-c C-c | |
1934 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed | |
1935 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line, or with the normal | |
1936 recalculation commands in the table. | |
1937 | |
1938 @subsubheading Debugging formulas | |
1939 @cindex formula debugging | |
1940 @cindex debugging, of table formulas | |
1941 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content | |
1942 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going | |
1943 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug, | |
1944 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the | |
1945 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a | |
1946 field. Detailed information will be displayed. | |
1947 | |
1948 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet | |
1949 @subsection Updating the Table | |
1950 @cindex recomputing table fields | |
1951 @cindex updating, table | |
1952 | |
1953 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be | |
1954 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features} for a way to make | |
1955 recalculation at least semi-automatically. | |
1956 | |
1957 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the | |
1958 following commands: | |
1959 | |
1960 @table @kbd | |
1961 @kindex C-c * | |
1962 @item C-c * | |
1963 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas | |
1964 from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row. | |
1965 @c | |
1966 @kindex C-u C-c * | |
1967 @item C-u C-c * | |
1968 @kindex C-u C-c C-c | |
1969 @itemx C-u C-c C-c | |
1970 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first | |
1971 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header. | |
1972 @c | |
1973 @kindex C-u C-u C-c * | |
1974 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-c | |
1975 @item C-u C-u C-c * | |
1976 @itemx C-u C-u C-c C-c | |
1977 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur. | |
1978 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other | |
1979 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence. | |
1980 @end table | |
1981 | |
1982 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet | |
1983 @subsection Advanced features | |
1984 | |
1985 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if | |
1986 you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need | |
1987 to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters. | |
1988 @table @kbd | |
1989 @kindex C-# | |
1990 @item C-# | |
1991 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{}, | |
1992 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. The meaning of these characters | |
1993 is discussed below. When there is an active region, change all marks in | |
1994 the region. | |
1995 @end table | |
1996 | |
1997 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and | |
1998 makes use of these features: | |
1999 | |
2000 @example | |
2001 @group | |
2002 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| | |
2003 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note | | |
2004 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| | |
2005 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | | | |
2006 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 | | |
2007 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | | | |
2008 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| | |
2009 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 | | |
2010 | # | Sara | 6 | 14 | 19 | 39 | 7.8 | | |
2011 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 | | |
2012 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| | |
2013 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | | | |
2014 | ^ | | | | | at | | | |
2015 | $ | max=50 | | | | | | | |
2016 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| | |
2017 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f | |
2018 @end group | |
2019 @end example | |
2020 | |
2021 @noindent @b{Important}: Please note that for these special tables, | |
2022 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that | |
2023 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned | |
2024 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with | |
2025 empty first field. | |
2026 | |
2027 @cindex marking characters, tables | |
2028 The marking characters have the following meaning: | |
2029 @table @samp | |
2030 @item ! | |
2031 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may | |
2032 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}. | |
2033 @item ^ | |
2034 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such | |
2035 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to | |
2036 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it | |
2037 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}. | |
2038 @item _ | |
2039 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row | |
2040 @emph{below}. | |
2041 @item $ | |
2042 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For | |
2043 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then | |
2044 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}. | |
2045 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on | |
2046 a per-table basis. | |
2047 @item # | |
2048 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing | |
2049 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row | |
2050 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked | |
2051 lines will be left alone by this command. | |
2052 @item * | |
2053 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but | |
2054 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic | |
2055 recalculation slows down editing too much. | |
2056 @item | |
2057 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. | |
2058 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#} | |
2059 or @samp{*}. | |
2060 @item / | |
2061 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing | |
2062 @samp{<N>} markers. | |
2063 @end table | |
2064 | |
2065 Finally, just to whet your appetite on what can be done with the | |
2066 fantastic @file{calc} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor | |
2067 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of functions | |
2068 (homework: try that with Excel :-) | |
2069 | |
2070 @example | |
2071 @group | |
2072 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------| | |
2073 | | Func | n | x | Result | | |
2074 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------| | |
2075 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x | | |
2076 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 | | |
2077 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 | | |
2078 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 | | |
2079 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 | | |
2080 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 | | |
2081 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------| | |
2082 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3 | |
2083 @end group | |
2084 @end example | |
2085 | |
2086 @node Hyperlinks, TODO items, Tables, Top | |
2087 @chapter Hyperlinks | |
2088 @cindex hyperlinks | |
2089 | |
2090 Just like HTML, Org-mode provides links inside a file, and external | |
2091 links to other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more. | |
2092 | |
2093 @menu | |
2094 * Link format:: How links in Org-mode are formatted | |
2095 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file | |
2096 * External links:: URL-like links to the world | |
2097 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following | |
2098 * Using links outside Org-mode:: Linking from my C source code? | |
2099 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links | |
2100 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location | |
2101 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough | |
2102 * Remember:: Org-trees store quick notes | |
2103 @end menu | |
2104 | |
2105 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks | |
2106 @section Link format | |
2107 @cindex link format | |
2108 @cindex format, of links | |
2109 | |
2110 Org-mode will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as | |
2111 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this: | |
2112 | |
2113 @example | |
2114 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]] | |
2115 @end example | |
2116 | |
2117 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org-mode | |
2118 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead | |
2119 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of | |
2120 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link}, | |
2121 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the | |
2122 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link} | |
2123 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To | |
2124 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the | |
2125 cursor on the link. | |
2126 | |
2127 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the | |
2128 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the | |
2129 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete | |
2130 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the | |
2131 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the | |
2132 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry | |
2133 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}. | |
2134 | |
2135 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks | |
2136 @section Internal links | |
2137 @cindex internal links | |
2138 @cindex links, internal | |
2139 @cindex targets, for links | |
2140 | |
2141 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in | |
2142 the current file. Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My | |
2143 Target][Find my target]]} lead to a text search in the current file. | |
2144 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the | |
2145 link, or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). The preferred | |
2146 match for such a link is a dedicated target: the same string in double | |
2147 angular brackets. Targets may be located anywhere; sometimes it is | |
2148 convenient to put them into a comment line. For example | |
2149 | |
2150 @example | |
2151 # <<My Target>> | |
2152 @end example | |
2153 | |
2154 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become | |
2155 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note | |
2156 that text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the | |
2157 first such target should be after the first headline.}. | |
2158 | |
2159 If no dedicated target exists, Org-mode will search for the words in the | |
2160 link. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}. | |
2161 Links starting with a star like @samp{*My Target} restrict the search to | |
2162 headlines. When searching, Org-mode will first try an exact match, but | |
2163 then move on to more and more lenient searches. For example, the link | |
2164 @samp{[[*My Targets]]} will find any of the following: | |
2165 | |
2166 @example | |
2167 ** My targets | |
2168 ** TODO my targets are bright | |
2169 ** my 20 targets are | |
2170 @end example | |
2171 | |
2172 To insert a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. | |
2173 Just type a star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and | |
2174 press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be | |
2175 offered as completions. @xref{Handling links}, for more commands | |
2176 creating links. | |
2177 | |
2178 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org-mode's own mark ring. You can | |
2179 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command | |
2180 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded | |
2181 earlier. | |
2182 | |
2183 @menu | |
2184 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text. | |
2185 @end menu | |
2186 | |
2187 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links | |
2188 @subsection Radio targets | |
2189 @cindex radio targets | |
2190 @cindex targets, radio | |
2191 @cindex links, radio targets | |
2192 | |
2193 Org-mode can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names | |
2194 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the | |
2195 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are | |
2196 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My | |
2197 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to | |
2198 become activated as a link. The Org-mode file is scanned automatically | |
2199 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To | |
2200 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the | |
2201 cursor on or at a target. | |
2202 | |
2203 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks | |
2204 @section External links | |
2205 @cindex links, external | |
2206 @cindex external links | |
2207 @cindex links, external | |
2208 @cindex GNUS links | |
2209 @cindex BBDB links | |
2210 @cindex URL links | |
2211 @cindex file links | |
2212 @cindex VM links | |
2213 @cindex RMAIL links | |
2214 @cindex WANDERLUST links | |
2215 @cindex MH-E links | |
2216 @cindex USENET links | |
2217 @cindex SHELL links | |
2218 @cindex Info links | |
2219 @cindex elisp links | |
2220 | |
2221 Org-mode supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages, | |
2222 and BBDB database entries. External links are URL-like locators. They | |
2223 start with a short identifying string followed by a colon. There can be | |
2224 no space after the colon. The following list shows examples for each | |
2225 link type. | |
2226 | |
2227 @example | |
2228 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web} | |
2229 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path} | |
2230 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path} | |
2231 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link} | |
2232 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link} | |
2233 vm:folder @r{VM folder link} | |
2234 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link} | |
2235 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine} | |
2236 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link} | |
2237 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link} | |
2238 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link} | |
2239 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link} | |
2240 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link} | |
2241 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link} | |
2242 gnus:group @r{GNUS group link} | |
2243 gnus:group#id @r{GNUS article link} | |
2244 bbdb:Richard Stallman @r{BBDB link} | |
2245 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command} | |
2246 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{An elisp form to evaluate} | |
2247 @end example | |
2248 | |
2249 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a | |
2250 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the url (@pxref{Link | |
2251 format}), for example: | |
2252 | |
2253 @example | |
2254 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]] | |
2255 @end example | |
2256 | |
2257 @noindent | |
2258 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML | |
2259 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable | |
2260 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an | |
2261 image, | |
2262 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file. | |
2263 | |
2264 @cindex angular brackets, around links | |
2265 @cindex plain text external links | |
2266 Org-mode also finds external links in the normal text and activates them | |
2267 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in | |
2268 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities | |
2269 about the end of the link, enclose them in angular brackets. | |
2270 | |
2271 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org-mode, External links, Hyperlinks | |
2272 @section Handling links | |
2273 @cindex links, handling | |
2274 | |
2275 Org-mode provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to | |
2276 insert it into an org-mode file, and to follow the link. | |
2277 | |
2278 @table @kbd | |
2279 @kindex C-c l | |
2280 @cindex storing links | |
2281 @item C-c l | |
2282 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command | |
2283 which can be used in any buffer to create a link. The link will be | |
2284 stored for later insertion into an Org-mode buffer (see below). For | |
2285 Org-mode files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link | |
2286 points to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline. For | |
2287 VM, RMAIL, WANDERLUST, MH-E, GNUS and BBDB buffers, the link will | |
2288 indicate the current article/entry. For W3 and W3M buffers, the link | |
2289 goes to the current URL. For any other files, the link will point to | |
2290 the file, with a search string (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the | |
2291 contents of the current line. If there is an active region, the | |
2292 selected words will form the basis of the search string. If the | |
2293 automatically created link is not working correctly or accurately | |
2294 enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string and | |
2295 to do the search for particular file types - see @ref{Custom searches}. | |
2296 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion - see @ref{Installation}. | |
2297 @c | |
2298 @kindex C-c C-l | |
2299 @cindex link completion | |
2300 @cindex completion, of links | |
2301 @cindex inserting links | |
2302 @item C-c C-l | |
2303 Insert a link. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer. | |
2304 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the | |
2305 link type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. All links stored | |
2306 during the current session are part of the history for this prompt, so | |
2307 you can access them with @key{up} and @key{down}. Completion, on the | |
2308 other hand, will help you to insert valid link prefixes like | |
2309 @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes defined through link | |
2310 abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). The link will be inserted | |
2311 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will | |
2312 be removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later | |
2313 use, use a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the | |
2314 option @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a | |
2315 descriptive text. If some text was selected when this command is | |
2316 called, the selected text becomes the default description.@* Note that | |
2317 you don't have to use this command to insert a link. Links in Org-mode | |
2318 are plain text, and you can type or paste them straight into the buffer. | |
2319 By using this command, the links are automatically enclosed in double | |
2320 brackets, and you will be asked for the optional descriptive text. | |
2321 @c | |
2322 @c If the link is a @samp{file:} link and | |
2323 @c the linked file is located in the same directory as the current file or | |
2324 @c a subdirectory of it, the path of the file will be inserted relative to | |
2325 @c the current directory. | |
2326 @c | |
2327 @kindex C-u C-c C-l | |
2328 @cindex file name completion | |
2329 @cindex completion, of file names | |
2330 @item C-u C-c C-l | |
2331 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to | |
2332 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select | |
2333 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the | |
2334 directory of the current org file, if the linked file is in the current | |
2335 directory or in a subdirectory of it, or if the path is written relative | |
2336 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path | |
2337 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can | |
2338 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes. | |
2339 @c | |
2340 @item C-c C-l @r{(with cursor on existing link)} | |
2341 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the | |
2342 link and description parts of the link. | |
2343 @c | |
2344 @cindex following links | |
2345 @kindex C-c C-o | |
2346 @item C-c C-o | |
2347 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using | |
2348 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run vm/mh-e/wanderlust/rmail/gnus/bbdb | |
2349 for the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. | |
2350 When the cursor is on an internal link, this commands runs the | |
2351 corresponding search. When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, | |
2352 it creates the corresponding TAGS view. If the cursor is on a time | |
2353 stamp, it compiles the agenda for that date. Furthermore, it will visit | |
2354 text and remote files in @samp{file:} links with Emacs and select a | |
2355 suitable application for local non-text files. Classification of files | |
2356 is based on file extension only. See option @code{org-file-apps}. If | |
2357 you want to override the default application and visit the file with | |
2358 Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. | |
2359 @c | |
2360 @kindex mouse-2 | |
2361 @kindex mouse-1 | |
2362 @item mouse-2 | |
2363 @itemx mouse-1 | |
2364 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o} | |
2365 would. Under Emacs 22, also @kbd{mouse-1} will follow a link. | |
2366 @c | |
2367 @kindex mouse-3 | |
2368 @item mouse-3 | |
2369 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and | |
2370 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the | |
2371 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}. | |
2372 @c | |
2373 @cindex mark ring | |
2374 @kindex C-c % | |
2375 @item C-c % | |
2376 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return | |
2377 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically. | |
2378 @c | |
2379 @cindex links, returning to | |
2380 @kindex C-c & | |
2381 @item C-c & | |
2382 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the | |
2383 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this | |
2384 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of | |
2385 previously recorded positions. | |
2386 @c | |
2387 @kindex C-c C-x C-n | |
2388 @kindex C-c C-x C-p | |
2389 @cindex links, finding next/previous | |
2390 @item C-c C-x C-n | |
2391 @itemx C-c C-x C-p | |
2392 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of | |
2393 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key | |
2394 bindings for this are really too long, you might want to bind this also | |
2395 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} | |
2396 @lisp | |
2397 (add-hook 'org-load-hook | |
2398 (lambda () | |
2399 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link) | |
2400 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link))) | |
2401 @end lisp | |
2402 @end table | |
2403 | |
2404 @node Using links outside Org-mode, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks | |
2405 @section Using links outside Org-mode | |
2406 | |
2407 You can insert and follow links that have Org-mode syntax not only in | |
2408 Org-mode, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two | |
2409 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys | |
2410 yourself): | |
2411 | |
2412 @lisp | |
2413 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global) | |
2414 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global) | |
2415 @end lisp | |
2416 | |
2417 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org-mode, Hyperlinks | |
2418 @section Link abbreviations | |
2419 @cindex link abbreviations | |
2420 @cindex abbreviation, links | |
2421 | |
2422 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are | |
2423 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An | |
2424 abbreviated link looks like this | |
2425 | |
2426 @example | |
2427 [[linkword:tag][description]] | |
2428 @end example | |
2429 | |
2430 @noindent | |
2431 where the tag is optional. Such abbreviations are resolved according to | |
2432 the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist} that | |
2433 relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example: | |
2434 | |
2435 @lisp | |
2436 @group | |
2437 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist | |
2438 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=") | |
2439 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=") | |
2440 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/ | |
2441 nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST"))) | |
2442 @end group | |
2443 @end lisp | |
2444 | |
2445 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be | |
2446 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string | |
2447 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will | |
2448 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link. | |
2449 | |
2450 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with | |
2451 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with | |
2452 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]} and find out what the Org-mode author is | |
2453 doing besides Emacs hacking with @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}. | |
2454 | |
2455 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org-mode buffer, you | |
2456 can define them in the file with | |
2457 | |
2458 @example | |
2459 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id= | |
2460 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s | |
2461 @end example | |
2462 | |
2463 @noindent | |
2464 In-buffer completion @pxref{Completion} can be used after @samp{[} to | |
2465 complete link abbreviations. | |
2466 | |
2467 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks | |
2468 @section Search options in file links | |
2469 @cindex search option in file links | |
2470 @cindex file links, searching | |
2471 | |
2472 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a | |
2473 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a | |
2474 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward | |
2475 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For | |
2476 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling | |
2477 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search | |
2478 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the | |
2479 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}. | |
2480 | |
2481 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file | |
2482 link, together with an explanation: | |
2483 | |
2484 @example | |
2485 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]] | |
2486 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]] | |
2487 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]] | |
2488 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]] | |
2489 @end example | |
2490 | |
2491 @table @code | |
2492 @item 255 | |
2493 Jump to line 255. | |
2494 @item My Target | |
2495 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for | |
2496 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see | |
2497 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file | |
2498 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in | |
2499 the linked file. | |
2500 @item *My Target | |
2501 In an Org-mode file, restrict search to headlines. | |
2502 @item /regexp/ | |
2503 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs | |
2504 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the | |
2505 target file is in Org-mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a | |
2506 sparse tree with the matches. | |
2507 @c If the target file is a directory, | |
2508 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory. | |
2509 @end table | |
2510 | |
2511 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used | |
2512 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does | |
2513 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as | |
2514 @samp{[[find me]]} would. | |
2515 | |
2516 @node Custom searches, Remember, Search options, Hyperlinks | |
2517 @section Custom Searches | |
2518 @cindex custom search strings | |
2519 @cindex search strings, custom | |
2520 | |
2521 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the | |
2522 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all | |
2523 cases. For example, BibTeX database files have many entries like | |
2524 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings, | |
2525 because the only unique identification for a BibTeX entry is the | |
2526 citation key. | |
2527 | |
2528 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set | |
2529 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search | |
2530 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need | |
2531 to be added to the hook variables | |
2532 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and | |
2533 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these | |
2534 variables for more information. Org-mode actually uses this mechanism | |
2535 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as | |
2536 an implementation example. Search for @samp{BibTeX links} in the source | |
2537 file. | |
2538 | |
2539 | |
2540 @node Remember, , Custom searches, Hyperlinks | |
2541 @section Remember | |
2542 @cindex @file{remember.el} | |
2543 | |
2544 Another way to create org entries with links to other files is through | |
2545 the @i{remember} package by John Wiegley. @i{Remember} lets you store | |
2546 quick notes with little interruption of your work flow. See | |
2547 @uref{http://www.emacswiki.org/cgi-bin/wiki/RememberMode} for more | |
2548 information. The notes produced by @i{Remember} can be stored in | |
2549 different ways, and Org-mode files are a good target. Org-mode | |
2550 significantly expands the possibilities of @i{remember}: You may define | |
2551 templates for different note types, and to associate target files and | |
2552 headlines with specific templates. It also allows you to select the | |
2553 location where a note should be stored interactively, on the fly. | |
2554 | |
2555 @menu | |
2556 * Setting up remember:: Some code for .emacs to get things going | |
2557 * Remember templates:: Define the outline of different note types | |
2558 * Storing notes:: Directly get the note to where it belongs | |
2559 @end menu | |
2560 | |
2561 @node Setting up remember, Remember templates, Remember, Remember | |
2562 @subsection Setting up remember | |
2563 | |
2564 The following customization will tell @i{remember} to use org files as | |
2565 target, and to create annotations compatible with Org-mode links. | |
2566 | |
2567 @example | |
2568 (setq org-directory "~/path/to/my/orgfiles/") | |
2569 (setq org-default-notes-file "~/.notes") | |
2570 (setq remember-annotation-functions '(org-remember-annotation)) | |
2571 (setq remember-handler-functions '(org-remember-handler)) | |
2572 (add-hook 'remember-mode-hook 'org-remember-apply-template) | |
2573 @end example | |
2574 | |
2575 @node Remember templates, Storing notes, Setting up remember, Remember | |
2576 @subsection Remember templates | |
2577 @cindex templates, for remember | |
2578 | |
2579 In combination with Org-mode, you can use templates to generate | |
2580 different types of @i{remember} notes. For example, if you would like | |
2581 to use one template to create general TODO entries, another one for | |
2582 journal entries, and a third one for collecting random ideas, you could | |
2583 use: | |
2584 | |
2585 @example | |
2586 (setq org-remember-templates | |
2587 '((?t "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a" "~/org/TODO.org") | |
2588 (?j "* %U %?\n\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org") | |
2589 (?i "* %^@{Title@}\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "New Ideas"))) | |
2590 @end example | |
2591 | |
2592 @noindent In these entries, the character specifies how to select the | |
2593 template. The first string specifies the template. Two more (optional) | |
2594 strings give the file in which, and the headline under which the new | |
2595 note should be stored. The file defaults (if not present or @code{nil}) | |
2596 to @code{org-default-notes-file}, the heading to | |
2597 @code{org-remember-default-headline}. Both defaults help to get to the | |
2598 storing location quickly, but you can change the location interactively | |
2599 while storing the note. | |
2600 | |
2601 When you call @kbd{M-x remember} (or @kbd{M-x org-remember}) to remember | |
2602 something, org will prompt for a key to select the template (if you have | |
2603 more than one template) and then prepare the buffer like | |
2604 @example | |
2605 * TODO | |
2606 [[file:link to where you called remember]] | |
2607 @end example | |
2608 | |
2609 @noindent or | |
2610 | |
2611 @example | |
2612 * [2006-03-21 Tue 15:37] | |
2613 | |
2614 [[file:link to where you called remember]] | |
2615 @end example | |
2616 | |
2617 @noindent | |
2618 During expansion of the template, special @kbd{%}-escapes allow dynamic | |
2619 insertion of content: | |
2620 @example | |
2621 %^@{prompt@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.} | |
2622 %t @r{time stamp, date only} | |
2623 %T @r{time stamp with date and time} | |
2624 %u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive time stamps} | |
2625 %^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}} | |
2626 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}} | |
2627 %n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})} | |
2628 %a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}} | |
2629 %i @r{initial content, the region when remember is called with C-u.} | |
2630 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.} | |
2631 %^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.} | |
2632 %^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.} | |
2633 %:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below} | |
2634 @end example | |
2635 | |
2636 @noindent | |
2637 For specific link types, the following keywords will be defined: | |
2638 | |
2639 @example | |
2640 Link type | Available keywords | |
2641 -------------------+---------------------------------------------- | |
2642 bbdb | %:name %:company | |
2643 vm, wl, mh, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id | |
2644 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress | |
2645 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress | |
2646 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}} | |
2647 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields} | |
2648 w3, w3m | %:url | |
2649 info | %:file %:node | |
2650 calendar | %:date" | |
2651 @end example | |
2652 | |
2653 @noindent | |
2654 To place the cursor after template expansion use: | |
2655 | |
2656 @example | |
2657 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.} | |
2658 @end example | |
2659 | |
2660 @noindent | |
2661 If you change you mind about which template to use, call | |
2662 @code{org-remember} in the remember buffer. You may then select a new | |
2663 template that will be filled with the previous context information. | |
2664 | |
2665 @node Storing notes, , Remember templates, Remember | |
2666 @subsection Storing notes | |
2667 | |
2668 When you are finished preparing a note with @i{remember}, you have to press | |
2669 @kbd{C-c C-c} to file the note away. The handler first prompts for a | |
2670 target file - if you press @key{RET}, the value specified for the | |
2671 template is used. Then the command offers the headings tree of the | |
2672 selected file, with the cursor position at the default headline (if you | |
2673 had specified one in the template). You can either immediately press | |
2674 @key{RET} to get the note placed there. Or you can use the following | |
2675 keys to find a better location: | |
2676 @example | |
2677 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.} | |
2678 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.} | |
2679 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.} | |
2680 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.} | |
2681 u @r{One level up.} | |
2682 @c 0-9 @r{Digit argument.} | |
2683 @end example | |
2684 @noindent | |
2685 Pressing @key{RET} or @key{left} or @key{right} | |
2686 then leads to the following result. | |
2687 | |
2688 @multitable @columnfractions 0.2 0.15 0.65 | |
2689 @item @b{Cursor position} @tab @b{Key} @tab @b{Note gets inserted} | |
2690 @item buffer-start @tab @key{RET} @tab as level 2 heading at end of file | |
2691 @item on headline @tab @key{RET} @tab as sublevel of the heading at cursor | |
2692 @item @tab @key{left}/@key{right} @tab as same level, before/after current heading | |
2693 @item not on headline @tab @key{RET} | |
2694 @tab at cursor position, level taken from context. | |
2695 @end multitable | |
2696 | |
2697 So a fast way to store the note to its default location is to press | |
2698 @kbd{C-c C-c @key{RET} @key{RET}}. Even shorter would be @kbd{C-u C-c | |
2699 C-c}, which does the same without even asking for a file or showing the | |
2700 tree. | |
2701 | |
2702 Before inserting the text into a tree, the function ensures that the | |
2703 text has a headline, i.e. a first line that starts with a @samp{*}. | |
2704 If not, a headline is constructed from the current date and some | |
2705 additional data. If the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation} is | |
2706 non-nil, the entire text is also indented so that it starts in the | |
2707 same column as the headline (after the asterisks). | |
2708 | |
2709 | |
2710 @node TODO items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top | |
2711 @chapter TODO items | |
2712 @cindex TODO items | |
2713 | |
2714 Org-mode does not maintain TODO lists as a separate document. TODO | |
2715 items are an integral part of the notes file, because TODO items | |
2716 usually come up while taking notes! With Org-mode, you simply mark | |
2717 any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way, the | |
2718 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the | |
2719 item emerged is always present when you check. | |
2720 | |
2721 Of course, this technique causes TODO items to be scattered throughout | |
2722 your file. Org-mode provides methods to give you an overview over all | |
2723 things you have to do. | |
2724 | |
2725 @menu | |
2726 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries | |
2727 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments | |
2728 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others | |
2729 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces | |
2730 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists | |
2731 @end menu | |
2732 | |
2733 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO items, TODO items | |
2734 @section Basic TODO functionality | |
2735 | |
2736 Any headline can become a TODO item by starting it with the word TODO, | |
2737 for example: | |
2738 | |
2739 @example | |
2740 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune | |
2741 @end example | |
2742 | |
2743 @noindent | |
2744 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are: | |
2745 | |
2746 @table @kbd | |
2747 @kindex C-c C-t | |
2748 @cindex cycling, of TODO states | |
2749 @item C-c C-t | |
2750 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among | |
2751 | |
2752 @example | |
2753 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --. | |
2754 '--------------------------------' | |
2755 @end example | |
2756 | |
2757 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and | |
2758 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}). | |
2759 @kindex S-@key{right} | |
2760 @kindex S-@key{left} | |
2761 @item S-@key{right} | |
2762 @itemx S-@key{left} | |
2763 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Mostly | |
2764 useful if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO | |
2765 extensions}). | |
2766 @kindex C-c C-c | |
2767 @item C-c C-c | |
2768 Use the fast tag interface to quickly and directly select a specific | |
2769 TODO state. For this you need to assign keys to TODO state, like this: | |
2770 @example | |
2771 #+SEQ_TODO: TODO(t) STARTED(s) WAITING(w) | DONE(d) | |
2772 @end example | |
2773 @noindent See @ref{Per file keywords} and @ref{Setting tags} for more | |
2774 information. | |
2775 @kindex C-c C-v | |
2776 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO | |
2777 @item C-c C-v | |
2778 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds | |
2779 the entire buffer, but shows all TODO items and the headings hierarchy | |
2780 above them. With prefix arg, search for a specific TODO. You will be | |
2781 prompted for the keyword, and you can also give a list of keywords like | |
2782 @code{kwd1|kwd2|...}. With numerical prefix N, show the tree for the | |
2783 Nth keyword in the variable @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix | |
2784 args, find all TODO and DONE entries. | |
2785 @kindex C-c a t | |
2786 @item C-c a t | |
2787 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all | |
2788 agenda files (@pxref{Agenda views}) into a single buffer. The buffer is in | |
2789 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate | |
2790 the TODO entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}). | |
2791 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information. | |
2792 @kindex S-M-@key{RET} | |
2793 @item S-M-@key{RET} | |
2794 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one. | |
2795 @end table | |
2796 | |
2797 @node TODO extensions, Priorities, TODO basics, TODO items | |
2798 @section Extended use of TODO keywords | |
2799 @cindex extended TODO keywords | |
2800 | |
2801 The default implementation of TODO entries is just two states: TODO and | |
2802 DONE. You can use the TODO feature for more complicated things by | |
2803 configuring the variable @code{org-todo-keywords}. With special setup, | |
2804 the TODO keyword system can work differently in different files. | |
2805 | |
2806 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and | |
2807 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}). | |
2808 | |
2809 @menu | |
2810 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps | |
2811 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred the rest | |
2812 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way | |
2813 * Per file keywords:: Different files, different requirements | |
2814 @end menu | |
2815 | |
2816 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions | |
2817 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states | |
2818 @cindex TODO workflow | |
2819 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords | |
2820 | |
2821 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states | |
2822 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing | |
2823 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org-mode in a | |
2824 buffer.}: | |
2825 | |
2826 @lisp | |
2827 (setq org-todo-keywords | |
2828 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED"))) | |
2829 @end lisp | |
2830 | |
2831 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need | |
2832 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}. If | |
2833 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE | |
2834 state. | |
2835 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords | |
2836 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO | |
2837 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may | |
2838 also use a prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For | |
2839 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY. | |
2840 If you define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion (see | |
2841 @ref{Completion}) to insert these words into the buffer. Changing a | |
2842 todo state can be logged with a timestamp, see @ref{Tracking TODO state | |
2843 changes} for more information. | |
2844 | |
2845 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions | |
2846 @subsection TODO keywords as types | |
2847 @cindex TODO types | |
2848 @cindex names as TODO keywords | |
2849 @cindex types as TODO keywords | |
2850 | |
2851 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different | |
2852 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate | |
2853 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several | |
2854 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items | |
2855 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would | |
2856 be set up like this: | |
2857 | |
2858 @lisp | |
2859 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE"))) | |
2860 @end lisp | |
2861 | |
2862 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather | |
2863 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a | |
2864 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org-mode supports this style by | |
2865 adapting the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also | |
2866 true for the @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When | |
2867 used several times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, | |
2868 in order to first select the right type for a task. But when you return | |
2869 to the item after some time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will | |
2870 switch from any name directly to DONE. Use prefix arguments or | |
2871 completion to quickly select a specific name. You can also review the | |
2872 items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree by using a numeric prefix | |
2873 to @kbd{C-c C-v}. For example, to see all things Lucy has to do, you | |
2874 would use @kbd{C-3 C-c C-v}. To collect Lucy's items from all agenda | |
2875 files into a single buffer, you would use the prefix arg as well when | |
2876 creating the global todo list: @kbd{C-3 C-c t}. | |
2877 | |
2878 @node Multiple sets in one file, Per file keywords, TODO types, TODO extensions | |
2879 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file | |
2880 @cindex todo keyword sets | |
2881 | |
2882 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in | |
2883 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic | |
2884 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a | |
2885 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not | |
2886 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look | |
2887 like this: | |
2888 | |
2889 @lisp | |
2890 (setq org-todo-keywords | |
2891 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE") | |
2892 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED") | |
2893 (sequence "|" "CANCELED"))) | |
2894 @end lisp | |
2895 | |
2896 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org-mode to keep track | |
2897 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup, | |
2898 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from | |
2899 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to | |
2900 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially | |
2901 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a | |
2902 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands: | |
2903 | |
2904 @table @kbd | |
2905 @kindex C-S-@key{right} | |
2906 @kindex C-S-@key{left} | |
2907 @item C-S-@key{right} | |
2908 @itemx C-S-@key{left} | |
2909 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example, | |
2910 @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or @code{DONE} to | |
2911 @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to @code{CANCELED}. | |
2912 @kindex S-@key{right} | |
2913 @kindex S-@key{left} | |
2914 @item S-@key{right} | |
2915 @itemx S-@key{left} | |
2916 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through | |
2917 @emph{all} keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} | |
2918 would switch from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. | |
2919 @end table | |
2920 | |
2921 @node Per file keywords, , Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions | |
2922 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files | |
2923 @cindex keyword options | |
2924 @cindex per file keywords | |
2925 | |
2926 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in | |
2927 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines | |
2928 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file | |
2929 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you | |
2930 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the | |
2931 file: | |
2932 | |
2933 @example | |
2934 #+SEQ_TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED | |
2935 @end example | |
2936 or | |
2937 @example | |
2938 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE | |
2939 @end example | |
2940 | |
2941 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be: | |
2942 | |
2943 @example | |
2944 #+SEQ_TODO: TODO | DONE | |
2945 #+SEQ_TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED | |
2946 #+SEQ_TODO: | CANCELED | |
2947 @end example | |
2948 | |
2949 @cindex completion, of option keywords | |
2950 @kindex M-@key{TAB} | |
2951 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type | |
2952 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion. | |
2953 | |
2954 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword | |
2955 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword | |
2956 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you | |
2957 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use | |
2958 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes | |
2959 known to Org-mode@footnote{Org-mode parses these lines only when | |
2960 Org-mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the | |
2961 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org-mode | |
2962 for the current buffer.}. | |
2963 | |
2964 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, TODO extensions, TODO items | |
2965 @section Priorities | |
2966 @cindex priorities | |
2967 | |
2968 If you use Org-mode extensively to organize your work, you may end up | |
2969 with a number of TODO entries so large that you'd like to prioritize | |
2970 them. This can be done by placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the | |
2971 headline, like this | |
2972 | |
2973 @example | |
2974 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune | |
2975 @end example | |
2976 | |
2977 @noindent | |
2978 With its standard setup, Org-mode supports priorities @samp{A}, | |
2979 @samp{B}, and @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry | |
2980 without a cookie is treated as priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a | |
2981 difference only in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/Daily agenda}). | |
2982 | |
2983 @table @kbd | |
2984 @kindex @kbd{C-c ,} | |
2985 @item @kbd{C-c ,} | |
2986 Set the priority of the current headline. The command prompts for a | |
2987 priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}. When you press | |
2988 @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the headline. | |
2989 The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline and | |
2990 agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}). | |
2991 @c | |
2992 @kindex S-@key{up} | |
2993 @kindex S-@key{down} | |
2994 @item S-@key{up} | |
2995 @itemx S-@key{down} | |
2996 Increase/decrease priority of current headline. Note that these keys | |
2997 are also used to modify time stamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). | |
2998 Furthermore, these keys are also used by CUA-mode (@pxref{Conflicts}). | |
2999 @end table | |
3000 | |
3001 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables | |
3002 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and | |
3003 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set | |
3004 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that | |
3005 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest | |
3006 priority): | |
3007 | |
3008 @example | |
3009 #+PRIORITIES: A C B | |
3010 @end example | |
3011 | |
3012 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO items | |
3013 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks | |
3014 @cindex tasks, breaking down | |
3015 | |
3016 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable | |
3017 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO | |
3018 item, with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out | |
3019 of the global TODO list, see the | |
3020 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. Another possibility is the use | |
3021 of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a large number of subtasks | |
3022 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). | |
3023 | |
3024 | |
3025 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO items | |
3026 @section Checkboxes | |
3027 @cindex checkboxes | |
3028 | |
3029 Every item in a plain list (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made a checkbox | |
3030 by starting it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to | |
3031 TODO items (@pxref{TODO items}), but more lightweight. Checkboxes are | |
3032 not included into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split | |
3033 a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping | |
3034 list. To toggle a checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or try Piotr Zielinski's | |
3035 @file{org-mouse.el}. Here is an example of a checkbox list. | |
3036 | |
3037 @example | |
3038 * TODO Organize party [3/6] | |
3039 - call people [1/3] | |
3040 - [ ] Peter | |
3041 - [X] Sarah | |
3042 - [ ] Sam | |
3043 - [X] order food | |
3044 - [ ] think about what music to play | |
3045 - [X] talk to the neighbors | |
3046 @end example | |
3047 | |
3048 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes | |
3049 @cindex checkbox statistics | |
3050 The @samp{[3/6]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are | |
3051 cookies indicating how many checkboxes are present in this entry, and | |
3052 how many of them have been checked off. This can give you an idea on | |
3053 how many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The | |
3054 cookies can be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a | |
3055 plain list item. Each cookie covers all checkboxes structurally below | |
3056 that headline/item. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing | |
3057 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. In the first case you get an @samp{n | |
3058 out of m} result, in the second case you get information about the | |
3059 percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be | |
3060 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%], respectively}). | |
3061 | |
3062 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes: | |
3063 | |
3064 @table @kbd | |
3065 @kindex C-c C-c | |
3066 @item C-c C-c | |
3067 Toggle checkbox at point. With prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, | |
3068 which is considered to be an intermediate state. | |
3069 @kindex C-c C-x C-b | |
3070 @item C-c C-x C-b | |
3071 Toggle checkbox at point. | |
3072 @itemize @minus | |
3073 @item | |
3074 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region | |
3075 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. If you | |
3076 want to toggle all boxes in the region independently, use a prefix | |
3077 argument. | |
3078 @item | |
3079 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between | |
3080 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree). | |
3081 @item | |
3082 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point. | |
3083 @end itemize | |
3084 @kindex M-S-@key{RET} | |
3085 @item M-S-@key{RET} | |
3086 Insert a new item with a checkbox. | |
3087 This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item | |
3088 (@pxref{Plain lists}). | |
3089 @kindex C-c # | |
3090 @item C-c # | |
3091 Update the checkbox statistics in the current outline entry. When | |
3092 called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox | |
3093 statistic cookies are updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes | |
3094 with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. If you | |
3095 delete boxes or add/change them by hand, use this command to get things | |
3096 back into synch. Or simply toggle any checkbox twice with @kbd{C-c C-c}. | |
3097 @end table | |
3098 | |
3099 | |
3100 @node Tags, Properties and columns, TODO items, Top | |
3101 @chapter Tags | |
3102 @cindex tags | |
3103 @cindex headline tagging | |
3104 @cindex matching, tags | |
3105 @cindex sparse tree, tag based | |
3106 | |
3107 If you wish to implement a system of labels and contexts for | |
3108 cross-correlating information, an excellent way is to assign @i{tags} to | |
3109 headlines. Org-mode has extensive support for using tags. | |
3110 | |
3111 Every headline can contain a list of tags, at the end of the headline. | |
3112 Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and | |
3113 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon; like | |
3114 @samp{:WORK:}. Several tags can be specified like @samp{:WORK:URGENT:}. | |
3115 | |
3116 @menu | |
3117 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline | |
3118 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline | |
3119 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags | |
3120 @end menu | |
3121 | |
3122 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags | |
3123 @section Tag inheritance | |
3124 @cindex inheritance, of tags | |
3125 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match | |
3126 | |
3127 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a | |
3128 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as | |
3129 well. For example, in the list | |
3130 | |
3131 @example | |
3132 * Meeting with the French group :WORK: | |
3133 ** Summary by Frank :BOSS:NOTES: | |
3134 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :ACTION: | |
3135 @end example | |
3136 | |
3137 @noindent | |
3138 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:WORK:}, @samp{:BOSS:}, | |
3139 @samp{:NOTES:}, and @samp{:ACTION:}. When executing tag searches and | |
3140 Org-mode finds that a certain headline matches the search criterion, it | |
3141 will not check any sublevel headline, assuming that these likely also | |
3142 match, and that the list of matches can become very long. This may | |
3143 not be what you want, however, and you can influence inheritance and | |
3144 searching using the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and | |
3145 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}. | |
3146 | |
3147 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags | |
3148 @section Setting tags | |
3149 @cindex setting tags | |
3150 @cindex tags, setting | |
3151 | |
3152 @kindex M-@key{TAB} | |
3153 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline. | |
3154 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is | |
3155 also a special command for inserting tags: | |
3156 | |
3157 @table @kbd | |
3158 @kindex C-c C-c | |
3159 @item C-c C-c | |
3160 @cindex completion, of tags | |
3161 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org-mode will either offer | |
3162 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see | |
3163 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned | |
3164 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all | |
3165 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make | |
3166 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion, | |
3167 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}). | |
3168 @end table | |
3169 | |
3170 Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By | |
3171 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags | |
3172 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list | |
3173 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set | |
3174 the default tags for a given file with lines like | |
3175 | |
3176 @example | |
3177 #+TAGS: @@WORK @@HOME @@TENNISCLUB | |
3178 #+TAGS: Laptop Car PC Sailboat | |
3179 @end example | |
3180 | |
3181 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the | |
3182 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list | |
3183 in a specific file: Just add an empty TAGS option line to that file: | |
3184 | |
3185 @example | |
3186 #+TAGS: | |
3187 @end example | |
3188 | |
3189 The default support method for entering tags is minibuffer completion. | |
3190 However, Org-mode also implements a much better method: @emph{fast tag | |
3191 selection}. This method allows to select and deselect tags with a | |
3192 single key per tag. To function efficiently, you should assign unique | |
3193 keys to most tags. This can be done globally with | |
3194 | |
3195 @lisp | |
3196 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@WORK" . ?w) ("@@HOME" . ?h) ("Laptop" . ?l))) | |
3197 @end lisp | |
3198 | |
3199 @noindent or on a per-file basis with | |
3200 | |
3201 @example | |
3202 #+TAGS: @@WORK(w) @@HOME(h) @@TENNISCLUB(t) Laptop(l) PC(p) | |
3203 @end example | |
3204 | |
3205 @noindent | |
3206 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive. With | |
3207 curly braces@footnote{In @code{org-mode-alist} use | |
3208 @code{'(:startgroup)} and @code{'(:endgroup)}, respectively. Several | |
3209 groups are allowed.} | |
3210 | |
3211 @example | |
3212 #+TAGS: @{ @@WORK(w) @@HOME(h) @@TENNISCLUB(t) @} Laptop(l) PC(p) | |
3213 @end example | |
3214 | |
3215 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@WORK}, @samp{@@HOME}, | |
3216 and @samp{@@TENNISCLUB} should be selected. | |
3217 | |
3218 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of | |
3219 these lines to activate any changes. | |
3220 | |
3221 If at least one tag has a selection key, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will | |
3222 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited | |
3223 tags, the tags of the current headline, and a list of all legal tags | |
3224 with corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to | |
3225 tags which have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use | |
3226 the following keys: | |
3227 | |
3228 @table @kbd | |
3229 @item a-z... | |
3230 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of | |
3231 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually | |
3232 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group. | |
3233 @kindex @key{TAB} | |
3234 @item @key{TAB} | |
3235 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined | |
3236 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer. | |
3237 @kindex @key{SPC} | |
3238 @item @key{SPC} | |
3239 Clear all tags for this line. | |
3240 @kindex @key{RET} | |
3241 @item @key{RET} | |
3242 Accept the modified set. | |
3243 @item C-g | |
3244 Abort without installing changes. | |
3245 @item q | |
3246 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}. | |
3247 @item ! | |
3248 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an | |
3249 exception) assign several tags from such a group. | |
3250 @item C-c | |
3251 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below). | |
3252 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the | |
3253 selection window. | |
3254 @end table | |
3255 | |
3256 @noindent | |
3257 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With | |
3258 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@HOME}, | |
3259 @samp{Laptop} and @samp{PC} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c | |
3260 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@HOME} to | |
3261 @samp{@@WORK} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or | |
3262 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag | |
3263 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h | |
3264 @key{RET} @key{RET}}. | |
3265 | |
3266 If you find that most of the time, you need only a single keypress to | |
3267 modify your list of tags, set the variable | |
3268 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to | |
3269 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection - it will immediately exit | |
3270 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press | |
3271 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process | |
3272 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c | |
3273 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special | |
3274 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only | |
3275 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}. | |
3276 | |
3277 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags | |
3278 @section Tag searches | |
3279 @cindex tag searches | |
3280 @cindex searching for tags | |
3281 | |
3282 Once a tags system has been set up, it can be used to collect related | |
3283 information into special lists. | |
3284 | |
3285 @table @kbd | |
3286 @kindex C-c \ | |
3287 @item C-c \ | |
3288 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a | |
3289 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line. | |
3290 @kindex C-c a m | |
3291 @item C-c a m | |
3292 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files. | |
3293 @xref{Matching tags and properties}. | |
3294 @kindex C-c a M | |
3295 @item C-c a M | |
3296 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check | |
3297 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable | |
3298 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). | |
3299 @end table | |
3300 | |
3301 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag searches | |
3302 A @i{tags} search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and | |
3303 @samp{|} for OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. | |
3304 Parenthesis are currently not implemented. A tag may also be preceded | |
3305 by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic sugar for | |
3306 positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when @samp{+} | |
3307 or @samp{-} is present. Examples: | |
3308 | |
3309 @table @samp | |
3310 @item +WORK-BOSS | |
3311 Select headlines tagged @samp{:WORK:}, but discard those also tagged | |
3312 @samp{:BOSS:}. | |
3313 @item WORK|LAPTOP | |
3314 Selects lines tagged @samp{:WORK:} or @samp{:LAPTOP:}. | |
3315 @item WORK|LAPTOP&NIGHT | |
3316 Like before, but require the @samp{:LAPTOP:} lines to be tagged also | |
3317 @samp{NIGHT}. | |
3318 @end table | |
3319 | |
3320 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search | |
3321 If you are using multi-state TODO keywords (@pxref{TODO extensions}), it | |
3322 can be useful to also match on the TODO keyword. This can be done by | |
3323 adding a condition after a slash to a tags match. The syntax is similar | |
3324 to the tag matches, but should be applied with consideration: For | |
3325 example, a positive selection on several TODO keywords can not | |
3326 meaningfully be combined with boolean AND. However, @emph{negative | |
3327 selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To make sure that only | |
3328 lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword, use @kbd{C-c a | |
3329 M}, or equivalently start the todo part after the slash with @samp{!}. | |
3330 Examples: | |
3331 | |
3332 @table @samp | |
3333 @item WORK/WAITING | |
3334 Select @samp{:WORK:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO | |
3335 keyword @samp{WAITING}. | |
3336 @item WORK/!-WAITING-NEXT | |
3337 Select @samp{:WORK:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING} | |
3338 nor @samp{NEXT} | |
3339 @item WORK/+WAITING|+NEXT | |
3340 Select @samp{:WORK:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or | |
3341 @samp{NEXT}. | |
3342 @end table | |
3343 | |
3344 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search | |
3345 Any element of the tag/todo match can be a regular expression - in this | |
3346 case it must be enclosed in curly braces. For example, | |
3347 @samp{WORK+@{^BOSS.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag | |
3348 @samp{WORK} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{BOSS}. | |
3349 | |
3350 @cindex level, require for tags match | |
3351 You can also require a headline to be of a certain level, by writing | |
3352 instead of any TAG an expression like @samp{LEVEL=3}. For example, a | |
3353 search @samp{+LEVEL=3+BOSS/-DONE} lists all level three headlines that | |
3354 have the tag BOSS and are @emph{not} marked with the todo keyword DONE. | |
3355 | |
3356 @node Properties and columns, Timestamps, Tags, Top | |
3357 @chapter Properties and Columns | |
3358 @cindex properties | |
3359 | |
3360 Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There | |
3361 are two main applications for properties in Org-mode. First, properties | |
3362 are like tags, but with a value. For example, in a file where you | |
3363 document bugs and plan releases of a piece of software, instead of using | |
3364 tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, it can be more | |
3365 efficient to use a property @code{RELEASE} with a value @code{1.0} or | |
3366 @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to implement (very basic) | |
3367 database capabilities in an Org-mode buffer, for example to create a | |
3368 list of Music CD's you own. You can edit and view properties | |
3369 conveniently in column view (@pxref{Column view}). | |
3370 | |
3371 @menu | |
3372 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out | |
3373 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features | |
3374 * Property searches:: Matching property values | |
3375 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing | |
3376 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers | |
3377 @end menu | |
3378 | |
3379 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and columns, Properties and columns | |
3380 @section Property Syntax | |
3381 @cindex property syntax | |
3382 @cindex drawer, for properties | |
3383 | |
3384 Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special | |
3385 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property | |
3386 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons) | |
3387 first, and the value after it. Here is an example: | |
3388 | |
3389 @example | |
3390 * CD collection | |
3391 ** Classic | |
3392 *** Goldberg Variations | |
3393 :PROPERTIES: | |
3394 :Title: Goldberg Variations | |
3395 :Composer: J.S. Bach | |
3396 :Artist: Glen Gould | |
3397 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammphon | |
3398 :NDisks: 1 | |
3399 :END: | |
3400 @end example | |
3401 | |
3402 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{XYZ} | |
3403 by setting a property @samp{XYZ_ALL}. This special property is | |
3404 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to | |
3405 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the | |
3406 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing | |
3407 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine | |
3408 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this: | |
3409 | |
3410 @example | |
3411 * CD collection | |
3412 :PROPERTIES: | |
3413 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4 | |
3414 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Phillips EMI | |
3415 :END: | |
3416 @end example | |
3417 | |
3418 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a | |
3419 file, use a line like | |
3420 | |
3421 @example | |
3422 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4 | |
3423 @end example | |
3424 | |
3425 Property values set with the global variable | |
3426 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all | |
3427 Org-mode files. | |
3428 | |
3429 @noindent | |
3430 The following commands help to work with properties: | |
3431 | |
3432 @table @kbd | |
3433 @kindex M-@key{TAB} | |
3434 @item M-@key{TAB} | |
3435 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used | |
3436 in the current file will be offered as possible completions. | |
3437 @item M-x org-insert-property-drawer | |
3438 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be | |
3439 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning | |
3440 information like deadlines. | |
3441 @kindex C-c C-c | |
3442 @item C-c C-c | |
3443 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands. | |
3444 @item C-c C-c s | |
3445 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value | |
3446 can be inserted using completion. | |
3447 @kindex S-@key{right} | |
3448 @kindex S-@key{left} | |
3449 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right} | |
3450 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value. | |
3451 @item C-c C-c d | |
3452 Remove a property from the current entry. | |
3453 @item C-c C-c D | |
3454 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file. | |
3455 @end table | |
3456 | |
3457 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and columns | |
3458 @section Special Properties | |
3459 @cindex properties, special | |
3460 | |
3461 Special properties provide alternative access method to Org-mode | |
3462 features discussed in the previous chapters, like the TODO state or the | |
3463 priority of an entry. This interface exists so that you can include | |
3464 these states into columns view (@pxref{Column view}). The following | |
3465 property names are special and should not be used as keys in the | |
3466 properties drawer: | |
3467 | |
3468 @example | |
3469 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.} | |
3470 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.} | |
3471 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.} | |
3472 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.} | |
3473 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.} | |
3474 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling time stamp, without the angular brackets.} | |
3475 @end example | |
3476 | |
3477 @node Property searches, Column view, Special properties, Properties and columns | |
3478 @section Property searches | |
3479 @cindex properties, searching | |
3480 | |
3481 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on | |
3482 properties, the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag | |
3483 searches}), and the same logic applies. For example, a search string | |
3484 | |
3485 @example | |
3486 +WORK-BOSS+PRIORITY="A"+coffee="unlimited"+with=@{Sarah\|Denny@} | |
3487 @end example | |
3488 | |
3489 @noindent | |
3490 finds entries tagged @samp{:WORK:} but not @samp{:BOSS:}, which | |
3491 also have a priority value @samp{A}, a @samp{:coffee:} property with the | |
3492 value @samp{unlimited}, and a @samp{:with:} property that is matched by | |
3493 the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}. | |
3494 | |
3495 @node Column view, Property API, Property searches, Properties and columns | |
3496 @section Column View | |
3497 | |
3498 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is | |
3499 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline item is turned into a | |
3500 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the | |
3501 entries. Org-mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure | |
3502 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned | |
3503 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline | |
3504 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS | |
3505 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view | |
3506 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each | |
3507 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse | |
3508 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items. | |
3509 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda views}) where | |
3510 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files. | |
3511 | |
3512 @menu | |
3513 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property | |
3514 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view | |
3515 @end menu | |
3516 | |
3517 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view | |
3518 @subsection Defining Columns | |
3519 @cindex column view, for properties | |
3520 @cindex properties, column view | |
3521 | |
3522 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is | |
3523 done by defining a column format line. | |
3524 | |
3525 @menu | |
3526 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid? | |
3527 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column | |
3528 @end menu | |
3529 | |
3530 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns | |
3531 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions | |
3532 | |
3533 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like | |
3534 | |
3535 @example | |
3536 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO | |
3537 @end example | |
3538 | |
3539 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a COLUMNS | |
3540 property to the top node of that tree, for example | |
3541 @example | |
3542 ** Top node for columns view | |
3543 :PROPERTIES: | |
3544 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO | |
3545 :END: | |
3546 @end example | |
3547 | |
3548 If a @code{COLUMNS} property is present in an entry, it defines columns | |
3549 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the | |
3550 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document, | |
3551 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all | |
3552 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a | |
3553 deeper part of the tree. | |
3554 | |
3555 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns | |
3556 @subsubsection Column attributes | |
3557 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general | |
3558 definition looks like this: | |
3559 | |
3560 @example | |
3561 %[width]property[(title)][@{summary-type@}] | |
3562 @end example | |
3563 | |
3564 @noindent | |
3565 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are | |
3566 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning: | |
3567 | |
3568 @example | |
3569 width @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.} | |
3570 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.} | |
3571 property @r{The property that should be edited in this column.} | |
3572 (title) @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the} | |
3573 @r{property name is used.} | |
3574 @{summary-type@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for} | |
3575 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.} | |
3576 @r{Supported summary types are:} | |
3577 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.} | |
3578 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM:SS, plain numbers are hours.} | |
3579 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, [X] if all children are [X].} | |
3580 @end example | |
3581 | |
3582 @noindent | |
3583 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed | |
3584 values. | |
3585 | |
3586 @example | |
3587 :COLUMNS: %20ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status %10Time_Spent@{:@} | |
3588 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don | |
3589 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" "" | |
3590 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]" | |
3591 @end example | |
3592 | |
3593 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the | |
3594 item itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the | |
3595 column definition with the ITEM specifier. The other specifiers create | |
3596 columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for | |
3597 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox | |
3598 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%} | |
3599 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order | |
3600 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a | |
3601 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will | |
3602 be created for the @samp{Time_Spent} column by adding time duration | |
3603 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing | |
3604 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. | |
3605 | |
3606 @node Using column view, , Defining columns, Column view | |
3607 @subsection Using Column View | |
3608 | |
3609 @table @kbd | |
3610 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off} | |
3611 @kindex C-c C-x C-c | |
3612 @item C-c C-x C-c | |
3613 Create the column view for the local environment. This command searches | |
3614 the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{COLUMNS} property that defines | |
3615 a format. When one is found, the column view table is established for | |
3616 the entire tree, starting from the entry that contains the @code{COLUMNS} | |
3617 property. If none is found, the format is taken from the @code{#+COLUMNS} | |
3618 line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format}, and column | |
3619 view is established for the current entry and its subtree. | |
3620 @kindex q | |
3621 @item q | |
3622 Exit column view. | |
3623 @tsubheading{Editing values} | |
3624 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down} | |
3625 Move through the column view from field to field. | |
3626 @kindex S-@key{left} | |
3627 @kindex S-@key{right} | |
3628 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right} | |
3629 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you | |
3630 have to have specified allowed values for a property. | |
3631 @kindex n | |
3632 @kindex p | |
3633 @itemx n / p | |
3634 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} | |
3635 @kindex e | |
3636 @item e | |
3637 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will | |
3638 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that | |
3639 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion | |
3640 or fast selection interface will pop up. | |
3641 @kindex v | |
3642 @item v | |
3643 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of | |
3644 the column is smaller than that of the value. | |
3645 @kindex a | |
3646 @item a | |
3647 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found | |
3648 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is | |
3649 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the | |
3650 current column view. | |
3651 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure} | |
3652 @kindex < | |
3653 @kindex > | |
3654 @item < / > | |
3655 Make the column narrower/wider by one character. | |
3656 @kindex S-M-@key{right} | |
3657 @item S-M-@key{right} | |
3658 Insert a new column, to the right of the current column. | |
3659 @kindex S-M-@key{left} | |
3660 @item S-M-@key{left} | |
3661 Delete the current column. | |
3662 @end table | |
3663 | |
3664 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and columns | |
3665 @section The Property API | |
3666 @cindex properties, API | |
3667 @cindex API, for properties | |
3668 | |
3669 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can | |
3670 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement | |
3671 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the | |
3672 property API}. | |
3673 | |
3674 @node Timestamps, Agenda views, Properties and columns, Top | |
3675 @chapter Timestamps | |
3676 @cindex time stamps | |
3677 @cindex date stamps | |
3678 | |
3679 Items can be labeled with timestamps to make them useful for project | |
3680 planning. | |
3681 | |
3682 @menu | |
3683 * Time stamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry | |
3684 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps | |
3685 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work | |
3686 * Progress logging:: Documenting when what work was done. | |
3687 @end menu | |
3688 | |
3689 | |
3690 @node Time stamps, Creating timestamps, Timestamps, Timestamps | |
3691 @section Time stamps, deadlines and scheduling | |
3692 @cindex time stamps | |
3693 @cindex ranges, time | |
3694 @cindex date stamps | |
3695 @cindex deadlines | |
3696 @cindex scheduling | |
3697 | |
3698 A time stamp is a specification of a date (possibly with time or a range | |
3699 of times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or | |
3700 @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue | |
3701 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is the standard ISO date/time format. If | |
3702 you cannot get used to these, see @ref{Custom time format}}. A time | |
3703 stamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an org-tree entry. | |
3704 Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda | |
3705 (@pxref{Weekly/Daily agenda}). We distinguish: | |
3706 | |
3707 @table @var | |
3708 @item Plain time stamp | |
3709 @cindex timestamp | |
3710 A simple time stamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just | |
3711 like writing down an appointment in a paper agenda, or like writing down | |
3712 an event in a diary, when you want to take note of when something | |
3713 happened. In the timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry | |
3714 associated with a plain time stamp will be shown exactly on that date. | |
3715 | |
3716 @example | |
3717 * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15> | |
3718 * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00> | |
3719 @end example | |
3720 | |
3721 @item Time stamp with repeater interval | |
3722 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval | |
3723 A time stamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it | |
3724 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain | |
3725 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months(m), or years(y). The | |
3726 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday: | |
3727 | |
3728 @example | |
3729 * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w> | |
3730 @end example | |
3731 | |
3732 @item Diary-style sexp entries | |
3733 For more complex date specifications, Org-mode supports using the | |
3734 special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary | |
3735 package. For example | |
3736 | |
3737 @example | |
3738 * The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month | |
3739 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)> | |
3740 @end example | |
3741 | |
3742 @item Time/Date range | |
3743 @cindex timerange | |
3744 @cindex date range | |
3745 Two time stamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline | |
3746 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates | |
3747 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example: | |
3748 | |
3749 @example | |
3750 ** Meeting in Amsterdam | |
3751 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu> | |
3752 @end example | |
3753 | |
3754 @item Inactive time stamp | |
3755 @cindex timestamp, inactive | |
3756 @cindex inactive timestamp | |
3757 Just like a plain time stamp, but with square brackets instead of | |
3758 angular ones. These time stamps are inactive in the sense that they do | |
3759 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda. | |
3760 | |
3761 @example | |
3762 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed] | |
3763 @end example | |
3764 | |
3765 @end table | |
3766 | |
3767 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Time stamps, Timestamps | |
3768 @section Creating timestamps | |
3769 @cindex creating timestamps | |
3770 @cindex timestamps, creating | |
3771 | |
3772 For Org-mode to recognize time stamps, they need to be in the specific | |
3773 format. All commands listed below produce time stamps in the correct | |
3774 format. | |
3775 | |
3776 @table @kbd | |
3777 @kindex C-c . | |
3778 @item C-c . | |
3779 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding time stamp. When the | |
3780 cursor is at a previously used time stamp, it is updated to NOW. When | |
3781 this command is used twice in succession, a time range is inserted. | |
3782 @c | |
3783 @kindex C-u C-c . | |
3784 @item C-u C-c . | |
3785 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but use the alternative format which contains date | |
3786 and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5 minutes, | |
3787 see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}. | |
3788 @c | |
3789 @kindex C-c ! | |
3790 @item C-c ! | |
3791 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive time stamp that will not cause | |
3792 an agenda entry. | |
3793 @c | |
3794 @kindex C-c < | |
3795 @item C-c < | |
3796 Insert a time stamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar. | |
3797 @c | |
3798 @kindex C-c > | |
3799 @item C-c > | |
3800 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a | |
3801 timestamp in the current line, goto the corresponding date | |
3802 instead. | |
3803 @c | |
3804 @kindex C-c C-o | |
3805 @item C-c C-o | |
3806 Access the agenda for the date given by the time stamp or -range at | |
3807 point (@pxref{Weekly/Daily agenda}). | |
3808 @c | |
3809 @kindex S-@key{left} | |
3810 @kindex S-@key{right} | |
3811 @item S-@key{left} | |
3812 @itemx S-@key{right} | |
3813 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with | |
3814 CUA-mode (@pxref{Conflicts}). | |
3815 @c | |
3816 @kindex S-@key{up} | |
3817 @kindex S-@key{down} | |
3818 @item S-@key{up} | |
3819 @itemx S-@key{down} | |
3820 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a | |
3821 year, month, day, hour or minute. Note that if the cursor is in a | |
3822 headline and not at a time stamp, these same keys modify the priority of | |
3823 an item. (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with | |
3824 CUA-mode (@pxref{Conflicts}). | |
3825 @c | |
3826 @kindex C-c C-y | |
3827 @cindex evaluate time range | |
3828 @item C-c C-y | |
3829 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and | |
3830 end. With prefix arg, insert result after the time range (in a table: | |
3831 into the following column). | |
3832 @end table | |
3833 | |
3834 | |
3835 @menu | |
3836 * The date/time prompt:: How org-mode helps you entering date and time | |
3837 * Custom time format:: Making dates look differently | |
3838 @end menu | |
3839 | |
3840 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps | |
3841 @subsection The date/time prompt | |
3842 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer | |
3843 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer | |
3844 | |
3845 When Org-mode prompts for a date/time, the prompt suggests to enter an | |
3846 ISO date. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date | |
3847 and/or time information. You can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a | |
3848 (possibly multi-line) string copied from an email message. Org-mode | |
3849 will find whatever information is in there and will replace anything not | |
3850 specified with the current date and time. For example: | |
3851 | |
3852 @example | |
3853 3-2-5 --> 2003-02-05 | |
3854 feb 15 --> currentyear-02-15 | |
3855 sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12 | |
3856 12:45 --> today 12:45 | |
3857 22 sept 0:34 --> currentyear-09-22 0:34 | |
3858 12 --> currentyear-currentmonth-12 | |
3859 Fri --> nearest Friday (today or later) | |
3860 +4 --> 4 days from now (if +N is the only thing given) | |
3861 @end example | |
3862 | |
3863 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If | |
3864 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure | |
3865 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}. | |
3866 | |
3867 @cindex calendar, for selecting date | |
3868 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If | |
3869 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable | |
3870 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date | |
3871 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing | |
3872 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the | |
3873 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully | |
3874 from the minibuffer: | |
3875 | |
3876 @table @kbd | |
3877 @kindex < | |
3878 @item < | |
3879 Scroll calendar backwards by one month. | |
3880 @kindex > | |
3881 @item > | |
3882 Scroll calendar forwards by one month. | |
3883 @kindex mouse-1 | |
3884 @item mouse-1 | |
3885 Select date by clicking on it. | |
3886 @kindex S-@key{right} | |
3887 @item S-@key{right} | |
3888 One day forward. | |
3889 @kindex S-@key{left} | |
3890 @item S-@key{left} | |
3891 One day back. | |
3892 @kindex S-@key{down} | |
3893 @item S-@key{down} | |
3894 One week forward. | |
3895 @kindex S-@key{up} | |
3896 @item S-@key{up} | |
3897 One week back. | |
3898 @kindex M-S-@key{right} | |
3899 @item M-S-@key{right} | |
3900 One month forward. | |
3901 @kindex M-S-@key{left} | |
3902 @item M-S-@key{left} | |
3903 One month back. | |
3904 @kindex @key{RET} | |
3905 @item @key{RET} | |
3906 Choose date in calendar (only if nothing was typed into minibuffer). | |
3907 @end table | |
3908 | |
3909 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps | |
3910 @subsection Custom time format | |
3911 @cindex custom date/time format | |
3912 @cindex time format, custom | |
3913 @cindex date format, custom | |
3914 | |
3915 Org-mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is | |
3916 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another | |
3917 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by | |
3918 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and | |
3919 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}. | |
3920 | |
3921 @table @kbd | |
3922 @kindex C-c C-x C-t | |
3923 @item C-c C-x C-t | |
3924 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times. | |
3925 @end table | |
3926 | |
3927 @noindent | |
3928 Org-mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time | |
3929 format does not @emph{replace} the default format - instead it is put | |
3930 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the | |
3931 following consequences: | |
3932 @itemize @bullet | |
3933 @item | |
3934 You cannot place the cursor onto a time stamp anymore, only before or | |
3935 after. | |
3936 @item | |
3937 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust | |
3938 each component of a time stamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of | |
3939 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day, | |
3940 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the | |
3941 time will be changed by one minute. | |
3942 @item | |
3943 If the time stamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these | |
3944 will not be overlayed, but remain in the buffer as they were. | |
3945 @item | |
3946 When you delete a time stamp character-by-character, it will only | |
3947 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters | |
3948 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed. | |
3949 @item | |
3950 If the custom time stamp format is longer than the default and you are | |
3951 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom | |
3952 format is shorter, things do work as expected. | |
3953 @end itemize | |
3954 | |
3955 | |
3956 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Progress logging, Creating timestamps, Timestamps | |
3957 @section Deadlines and Scheduling | |
3958 | |
3959 A time stamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning | |
3960 of work: | |
3961 | |
3962 @table @var | |
3963 @item DEADLINE | |
3964 @cindex DEADLINE keyword | |
3965 The task (most likely a TODO item) is supposed to be finished on that | |
3966 date, and it will be listed then. In addition, the compilation for | |
3967 @emph{today} will carry a warning about the approaching or missed | |
3968 deadline, starting @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, | |
3969 and continuing until the entry is marked DONE. An example: | |
3970 | |
3971 @example | |
3972 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide | |
3973 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]] | |
3974 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun> | |
3975 @end example | |
3976 | |
3977 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific | |
3978 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning | |
3979 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}. | |
3980 | |
3981 @item SCHEDULED | |
3982 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword | |
3983 You are planning to start working on that task on the given date. The | |
3984 headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still be | |
3985 listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like | |
3986 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In | |
3987 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present | |
3988 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE. | |
3989 I.e., the task will automatically be forwarded until completed. | |
3990 | |
3991 @example | |
3992 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve. | |
3993 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat> | |
3994 @end example | |
3995 @end table | |
3996 | |
3997 @menu | |
3998 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items | |
3999 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again | |
4000 @end menu | |
4001 | |
4002 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling | |
4003 @subsection Inserting deadline/schedule | |
4004 | |
4005 The following commands allow to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule | |
4006 an item: | |
4007 | |
4008 @table @kbd | |
4009 @c | |
4010 @kindex C-c C-d | |
4011 @item C-c C-d | |
4012 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will | |
4013 happen in the line directly following the headline. | |
4014 @c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.???????? | |
4015 @c | |
4016 @kindex C-c C-w | |
4017 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines | |
4018 @item C-c C-w | |
4019 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or | |
4020 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}. | |
4021 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric | |
4022 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c C-w} shows | |
4023 all deadlines due tomorrow. | |
4024 @c | |
4025 @kindex C-c C-s | |
4026 @item C-c C-s | |
4027 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will | |
4028 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED | |
4029 timestamp will be removed. | |
4030 @end table | |
4031 | |
4032 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling | |
4033 @subsection Repeated Tasks | |
4034 | |
4035 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again, and Org-mode therefore | |
4036 allows to use a repeater in a DEADLINE or SCHEDULED time stamp, for | |
4037 example: | |
4038 @example | |
4039 ** TODO Pay the rent | |
4040 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m> | |
4041 @end example | |
4042 | |
4043 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they | |
4044 are over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as | |
4045 completed once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE | |
4046 with the todo keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the | |
4047 agenda. The problem with this is, however, that then also the | |
4048 @emph{next} instance of the repeated entry will not be active. Org-mode | |
4049 deals with this in the following way: When you try to mark such an entry | |
4050 DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will shift the base date of the repeating | |
4051 time stamp by the repeater interval, and immediately set the entry state | |
4052 back to TODO. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would | |
4053 actually switch the date like this: | |
4054 | |
4055 @example | |
4056 ** TODO Pay the rent | |
4057 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m> | |
4058 @end example | |
4059 | |
4060 You will also be prompted for a note that will be put under the DEADLINE | |
4061 line to keep a record that you actually acted on the previous instance | |
4062 of this deadline. | |
4063 | |
4064 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be | |
4065 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances | |
4066 will be visible. | |
4067 | |
4068 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific | |
4069 task - just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same. | |
4070 | |
4071 @node Progress logging, , Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps | |
4072 @section Progress Logging | |
4073 @cindex progress logging | |
4074 @cindex logging, of progress | |
4075 | |
4076 Org-mode can automatically record a time stamp when you mark a TODO item | |
4077 as DONE, or even each time when you change the state of a TODO item. | |
4078 You can also measure precisely the time you spent on specific items in a | |
4079 project by starting and stopping a clock when you start and stop working | |
4080 on an aspect of a project. | |
4081 | |
4082 @menu | |
4083 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE? | |
4084 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change? | |
4085 * Clocking work time:: When exactly did you work on this item? | |
4086 @end menu | |
4087 | |
4088 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging | |
4089 @subsection Closing items | |
4090 | |
4091 If you want to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO item was | |
4092 finished, turn on logging with@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer | |
4093 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}} | |
4094 | |
4095 @lisp | |
4096 (setq org-log-done t) | |
4097 @end lisp | |
4098 | |
4099 @noindent | |
4100 Then each time you turn a TODO entry into DONE using either @kbd{C-c | |
4101 C-t} in the Org-mode buffer or @kbd{t} in the agenda buffer, a line | |
4102 @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted just after the headline. If | |
4103 you turn the entry back into a TODO item through further state cycling, | |
4104 that line will be removed again. In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and | |
4105 in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/Daily agenda}), you can then use the | |
4106 @kbd{l} key to display the TODO items closed on each day, giving you an | |
4107 overview of what has been done on a day. If you want to record a note | |
4108 along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer | |
4109 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}} | |
4110 | |
4111 @lisp | |
4112 (setq org-log-done '(done)) | |
4113 @end lisp | |
4114 | |
4115 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Clocking work time, Closing items, Progress logging | |
4116 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes | |
4117 | |
4118 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow | |
4119 states}), you might want to keep track of when a state change occurred, | |
4120 and you may even want to attach notes to that state change. With the | |
4121 setting | |
4122 | |
4123 @lisp | |
4124 (setq org-log-done '(state)) | |
4125 @end lisp | |
4126 | |
4127 @noindent | |
4128 each state change will prompt you for a note that will be attached to | |
4129 the current headline. Very likely you do not want this verbose tracking | |
4130 all the time, so it is probably better to configure this behavior with | |
4131 in-buffer options. For example, if you are tracking purchases, put | |
4132 these into a separate file that starts with: | |
4133 | |
4134 @example | |
4135 #+SEQ_TODO: TODO ORDERED INVOICE PAYED RECEIVED SENT | |
4136 #+STARTUP: lognotestate | |
4137 @end example | |
4138 | |
4139 | |
4140 @node Clocking work time, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging | |
4141 @subsection Clocking work time | |
4142 | |
4143 Org-mode allows you to clock the time you spent on specific tasks in a | |
4144 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. | |
4145 When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the | |
4146 clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It | |
4147 also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. | |
4148 | |
4149 @table @kbd | |
4150 @kindex C-c C-x C-i | |
4151 @item C-c C-x C-i | |
4152 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK | |
4153 keyword together with a timestamp. | |
4154 @kindex C-c C-x C-o | |
4155 @item C-c C-x C-o | |
4156 Stop the clock (clock-out). The inserts another timestamp at the same | |
4157 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes | |
4158 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=> | |
4159 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-done} for the possibility to | |
4160 record an additional note together with the clock-out time | |
4161 stamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: | |
4162 lognoteclock-out}}. | |
4163 @kindex C-c C-y | |
4164 @item C-c C-y | |
4165 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the time stamps. This | |
4166 is only necessary if you edit the time stamps directly. If you change | |
4167 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic. | |
4168 @kindex C-c C-t | |
4169 @item C-c C-t | |
4170 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock | |
4171 if it is running in this same item. | |
4172 @kindex C-c C-x C-x | |
4173 @item C-c C-x C-x | |
4174 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by | |
4175 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else. | |
4176 @kindex C-c C-x C-d | |
4177 @item C-c C-x C-d | |
4178 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This | |
4179 puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time | |
4180 recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You | |
4181 can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear | |
4182 when you change the buffer (see variable | |
4183 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}. | |
4184 @kindex C-c C-x C-r | |
4185 @item C-c C-x C-r | |
4186 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock | |
4187 report as an org-mode table into the current file. | |
4188 @example | |
4189 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil | |
4190 | |
4191 #+END: clocktable | |
4192 @end example | |
4193 @noindent | |
4194 If such a block already exists, its content is replaced by the new | |
4195 table. The @samp{BEGIN} line can specify options: | |
4196 @example | |
4197 :maxlevels @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.} | |
4198 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items} | |
4199 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified relative} | |
4200 @r{to the current time and may be any of these keywords:} | |
4201 @r{@code{today}, @code{yesterday}, @code{thisweek}, @code{lastweek},} | |
4202 @r{@code{thismonth}, @code{lastmonth}, @code{thisyear}, or @code{lastyear}}. | |
4203 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times} | |
4204 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times} | |
4205 @end example | |
4206 So to get a clock summary for the current day, you could write | |
4207 @example | |
4208 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today | |
4209 | |
4210 #+END: clocktable | |
4211 @end example | |
4212 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all | |
4213 parameters must be specified in a single line - the line is broken here | |
4214 only to fit it onto the manual.} | |
4215 @example | |
4216 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>" | |
4217 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>" | |
4218 | |
4219 #+END: clocktable | |
4220 @end example | |
4221 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u | |
4222 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u | |
4223 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if | |
4224 you have several clocktable blocks in a buffer. | |
4225 @end table | |
4226 | |
4227 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in | |
4228 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/Daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been | |
4229 worked on or closed during a day. | |
4230 | |
4231 @node Agenda views, Embedded LaTeX, Timestamps, Top | |
4232 @chapter Agenda Views | |
4233 @cindex agenda views | |
4234 | |
4235 Due to the way Org-mode works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and | |
4236 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of | |
4237 files. To get an overview over open action items, or over events that | |
4238 are important for a particular date, this information must be collected, | |
4239 sorted and displayed in an organized way. | |
4240 | |
4241 Org-mode can select items based on various criteria, and display them | |
4242 in a separate buffer. Six different view types are provided: | |
4243 | |
4244 @itemize @bullet | |
4245 @item | |
4246 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information | |
4247 for specific dates, | |
4248 @item | |
4249 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished | |
4250 action items, | |
4251 @item | |
4252 a @emph{tags view}, showings headlines based on | |
4253 the tags associated with them, | |
4254 @item | |
4255 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org-mode file, | |
4256 in time-sorted view, | |
4257 @item | |
4258 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move | |
4259 along, and | |
4260 @item | |
4261 @emph{custom views} that are special tag/keyword searches and | |
4262 combinations of different views. | |
4263 @end itemize | |
4264 | |
4265 @noindent | |
4266 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda | |
4267 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the | |
4268 corresponding locations in the original Org-mode files, and even to | |
4269 edit these files remotely. | |
4270 | |
4271 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the | |
4272 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits: | |
4273 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and | |
4274 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}. | |
4275 | |
4276 @menu | |
4277 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information | |
4278 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views | |
4279 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box? | |
4280 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display | |
4281 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of org trees | |
4282 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views | |
4283 @end menu | |
4284 | |
4285 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda views, Agenda views | |
4286 @section Agenda files | |
4287 @cindex agenda files | |
4288 @cindex files for agenda | |
4289 | |
4290 The information to be shown is collected from all @emph{agenda files}, | |
4291 the files listed in the variable @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the | |
4292 value of that variable is not a list, but a single file name, then the | |
4293 list of agenda files will be maintained in that external file.}. Thus even | |
4294 if you only work with a single Org-mode file, this file should be put | |
4295 into that list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing @kbd{1} | |
4296 before selecting a command will actually limit the command to the | |
4297 current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next | |
4298 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but | |
4299 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands | |
4300 | |
4301 @cindex files, adding to agenda list | |
4302 @table @kbd | |
4303 @kindex C-c [ | |
4304 @item C-c [ | |
4305 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to | |
4306 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to | |
4307 the front. With prefix arg, file is added/moved to the end. | |
4308 @kindex C-c ] | |
4309 @item C-c ] | |
4310 Remove current file from the list of agenda files. | |
4311 @kindex C-, | |
4312 @kindex C-' | |
4313 @item C-, | |
4314 @itemx C-' | |
4315 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other. | |
4316 @end table | |
4317 | |
4318 @noindent | |
4319 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used | |
4320 to visit any of them. | |
4321 | |
4322 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda views | |
4323 @section The agenda dispatcher | |
4324 @cindex agenda dispatcher | |
4325 @cindex dispatching agenda commands | |
4326 The views are created through a dispatcher that should be bound to a | |
4327 global key, for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the | |
4328 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher | |
4329 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After | |
4330 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a | |
4331 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands: | |
4332 @table @kbd | |
4333 @item a | |
4334 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/Daily agenda}). | |
4335 @item t @r{/} T | |
4336 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}). | |
4337 @item m @r{/} M | |
4338 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching | |
4339 tags and properties}). | |
4340 @item L | |
4341 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}). | |
4342 @item # @r{/} ! | |
4343 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}). | |
4344 @item 1 | |
4345 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer. After pressing | |
4346 @kbd{1}, you still need to press the character selecting the command. | |
4347 @item 0 | |
4348 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to | |
4349 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree. After | |
4350 pressing @kbd{0}, you still need to press the character selecting the | |
4351 command. | |
4352 @end table | |
4353 | |
4354 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the | |
4355 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the | |
4356 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several | |
4357 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and | |
4358 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}. | |
4359 | |
4360 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda views | |
4361 @section The built-in agenda views | |
4362 | |
4363 In this section we describe the built-in views. | |
4364 | |
4365 @menu | |
4366 * Weekly/Daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks | |
4367 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items | |
4368 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search | |
4369 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file | |
4370 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review | |
4371 @end menu | |
4372 | |
4373 @node Weekly/Daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views | |
4374 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda | |
4375 @cindex agenda | |
4376 @cindex weekly agenda | |
4377 @cindex daily agenda | |
4378 | |
4379 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a | |
4380 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day. | |
4381 | |
4382 @table @kbd | |
4383 @cindex org-agenda, command | |
4384 @kindex C-c a a | |
4385 @item C-c a a | |
4386 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of org files. The | |
4387 agenda shows the entries for each day. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix (or | |
4388 when the variable @code{org-agenda-include-all-todo} is @code{t}), all | |
4389 unfinished TODO items (including those without a date) are also listed at | |
4390 the beginning of the buffer, before the first date.@* | |
4391 @end table | |
4392 | |
4393 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can | |
4394 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer. | |
4395 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda | |
4396 commands}. | |
4397 | |
4398 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration | |
4399 @cindex calendar integration | |
4400 @cindex diary integration | |
4401 | |
4402 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The | |
4403 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different | |
4404 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of | |
4405 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments | |
4406 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to | |
4407 Org-mode. It can be very useful to combine output from Org-mode with | |
4408 the diary. | |
4409 | |
4410 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org-mode's | |
4411 agenda, you only need to customize the variable | |
4412 | |
4413 @lisp | |
4414 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t) | |
4415 @end lisp | |
4416 | |
4417 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary | |
4418 entries including holidays, anniversaries etc will be included in the | |
4419 agenda buffer created by Org-mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and | |
4420 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary | |
4421 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to | |
4422 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as | |
4423 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display | |
4424 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other | |
4425 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth | |
4426 between calendar and agenda. | |
4427 | |
4428 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is | |
4429 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move | |
4430 the entries into an Org-mode file. Org-mode evaluates diary-style sexp | |
4431 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first | |
4432 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at | |
4433 the left margin, no white space is allowed before them. For example, | |
4434 the following segment of an Org-mode file will be processed and entries | |
4435 will be made in the agenda: | |
4436 | |
4437 @example | |
4438 * Birthdays and similar stuff | |
4439 #+CATEGORY: Holiday | |
4440 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names | |
4441 #+CATEGORY: Ann | |
4442 %%(diary-anniversary 14 5 1956) Arthur Dent is %d years old | |
4443 %%(diary-anniversary 2 10 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old | |
4444 @end example | |
4445 | |
4446 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/Daily agenda, Built-in agenda views | |
4447 @subsection The global TODO list | |
4448 @cindex global TODO list | |
4449 @cindex TODO list, global | |
4450 | |
4451 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items, formatted and | |
4452 collected into a single place. | |
4453 | |
4454 @table @kbd | |
4455 @kindex C-c a t | |
4456 @item C-c a t | |
4457 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all | |
4458 agenda files (@pxref{Agenda views}) into a single buffer. The buffer is in | |
4459 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate | |
4460 the TODO entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}). | |
4461 @kindex C-c a T | |
4462 @item C-c a T | |
4463 @cindex TODO keyword matching | |
4464 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You | |
4465 can also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. With | |
4466 a @kbd{C-u} prefix you are prompted for a keyword, and you may also | |
4467 specify several keywords by separating them with @samp{|} as boolean OR | |
4468 operator. With a numeric prefix, the Nth keyword in | |
4469 @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected. | |
4470 @kindex r | |
4471 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give | |
4472 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword, | |
4473 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific | |
4474 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@* | |
4475 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags | |
4476 search (@pxref{Tag searches}). | |
4477 @end table | |
4478 | |
4479 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a | |
4480 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the | |
4481 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}. | |
4482 | |
4483 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into todo list | |
4484 Normally the global todo list simply shows all headlines with TODO | |
4485 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep | |
4486 it more compact: | |
4487 @itemize @minus | |
4488 @item | |
4489 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for | |
4490 execution (@pxref{Time stamps}) as no longer @emph{open}. Configure the | |
4491 variable @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled} to exclude scheduled | |
4492 items from the global TODO list. | |
4493 @item | |
4494 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In | |
4495 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline | |
4496 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable | |
4497 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior. | |
4498 @end itemize | |
4499 | |
4500 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views | |
4501 @subsection Matching Tags and Properties | |
4502 @cindex matching, of tags | |
4503 @cindex matching, of properties | |
4504 @cindex tags view | |
4505 | |
4506 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} | |
4507 (@pxref{Tags}), you can select headlines based on the tags that apply | |
4508 to them and collect them into an agenda buffer. | |
4509 | |
4510 @table @kbd | |
4511 @kindex C-c a m | |
4512 @item C-c a m | |
4513 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The | |
4514 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic | |
4515 expression with tags, like @samp{+WORK+URGENT-WITHBOSS} or | |
4516 @samp{WORK|HOME} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search, | |
4517 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). | |
4518 @kindex C-c a M | |
4519 @item C-c a M | |
4520 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items | |
4521 and force checking subitems (see variable | |
4522 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). Matching specific todo keywords | |
4523 together with a tags match is also possible, see @ref{Tag searches}. | |
4524 @end table | |
4525 | |
4526 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda | |
4527 commands}. | |
4528 | |
4529 @node Timeline, Stuck projects, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views | |
4530 @subsection Timeline for a single file | |
4531 @cindex timeline, single file | |
4532 @cindex time-sorted view | |
4533 | |
4534 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org-mode | |
4535 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is | |
4536 to give an overview over events in a project. | |
4537 | |
4538 @table @kbd | |
4539 @kindex C-c a L | |
4540 @item C-c a L | |
4541 Show a time-sorted view of the org file, with all time-stamped items. | |
4542 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries | |
4543 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date. | |
4544 @end table | |
4545 | |
4546 @noindent | |
4547 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in | |
4548 @ref{Agenda commands}. | |
4549 | |
4550 | |
4551 @node Stuck projects, , Timeline, Built-in agenda views | |
4552 @subsection Stuck projects | |
4553 | |
4554 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your | |
4555 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure | |
4556 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that | |
4557 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists | |
4558 Org-mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such | |
4559 projects and define next actions for them. | |
4560 | |
4561 @table @kbd | |
4562 @kindex C-c a # | |
4563 @item C-c a # | |
4564 List projects that are stuck. | |
4565 @kindex C-c a ! | |
4566 @item C-c a ! | |
4567 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck | |
4568 project is and how to find it. | |
4569 @end table | |
4570 | |
4571 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will | |
4572 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are | |
4573 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least | |
4574 one entry marked with a todo keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION. | |
4575 | |
4576 Lets assume that you, in your own way of using Org-mode, identify | |
4577 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a todo keyword MAYBE to | |
4578 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Lets further | |
4579 assume that the todo keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT | |
4580 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and | |
4581 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project | |
4582 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed | |
4583 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects | |
4584 with a tags/todo match @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for | |
4585 TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that | |
4586 are not stuck. The correct customization for this is | |
4587 | |
4588 @lisp | |
4589 (setq org-stuck-projects | |
4590 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP") | |
4591 "\\<IGNORE\\>")) | |
4592 @end lisp | |
4593 | |
4594 | |
4595 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda views | |
4596 @section Presentation and sorting | |
4597 @cindex presentation, of agenda items | |
4598 | |
4599 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org-mode visually prepares | |
4600 the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line | |
4601 starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} | |
4602 (@pxref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can | |
4603 customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}. | |
4604 The prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline | |
4605 associated with the item. | |
4606 | |
4607 @menu | |
4608 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal | |
4609 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time | |
4610 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things | |
4611 @end menu | |
4612 | |
4613 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting | |
4614 @subsection Categories | |
4615 | |
4616 @cindex category | |
4617 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default, | |
4618 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also | |
4619 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this: | |
4620 | |
4621 @example | |
4622 #+CATEGORY: Thesis | |
4623 @end example | |
4624 | |
4625 If there are several such lines in a file, each specifies the category | |
4626 for the text below it (but the first category also applies to any text | |
4627 before the first CATEGORY line). The display in the agenda buffer looks | |
4628 best if the category is not longer than 10 characters. | |
4629 | |
4630 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting | |
4631 @subsection Time-of-Day Specifications | |
4632 @cindex time-of-day specification | |
4633 | |
4634 Org-mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The | |
4635 time can be part of the time stamp that triggered inclusion into the | |
4636 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time | |
4637 ranges can be specified with two time stamps, like | |
4638 @c | |
4639 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}. | |
4640 | |
4641 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as | |
4642 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}. If the agenda | |
4643 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/Daily agenda}), time | |
4644 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well. | |
4645 | |
4646 For agenda display, Org-mode extracts the time and displays it in a | |
4647 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in | |
4648 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this: | |
4649 | |
4650 @example | |
4651 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer | |
4652 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub | |
4653 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem | |
4654 20:30-22:15 Marwin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge | |
4655 @end example | |
4656 | |
4657 @cindex time grid | |
4658 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the | |
4659 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like | |
4660 | |
4661 @example | |
4662 8:00...... ------------------ | |
4663 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer | |
4664 10:00...... ------------------ | |
4665 12:00...... ------------------ | |
4666 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub | |
4667 14:00...... ------------------ | |
4668 16:00...... ------------------ | |
4669 18:00...... ------------------ | |
4670 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem | |
4671 20:00...... ------------------ | |
4672 20:30-22:15 Marwin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge | |
4673 @end example | |
4674 | |
4675 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable | |
4676 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with | |
4677 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}. | |
4678 | |
4679 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting | |
4680 @subsection Sorting of agenda items | |
4681 @cindex sorting, of agenda items | |
4682 @cindex priorities, of agenda items | |
4683 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is | |
4684 done depends on the type of view. | |
4685 @itemize @bullet | |
4686 @item | |
4687 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The | |
4688 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit | |
4689 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning | |
4690 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain | |
4691 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}. | |
4692 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}), | |
4693 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000 | |
4694 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for | |
4695 overdue scheduled or deadline items. | |
4696 @item | |
4697 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within | |
4698 each category, sorting takes place according to priority | |
4699 (@pxref{Priorities}). | |
4700 @item | |
4701 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the | |
4702 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files. | |
4703 @end itemize | |
4704 | |
4705 Sorting can be customized using the variable | |
4706 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}. | |
4707 | |
4708 | |
4709 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda views | |
4710 @section Commands in the agenda buffer | |
4711 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer | |
4712 | |
4713 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the org file or diary | |
4714 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda | |
4715 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the | |
4716 original entry location, and to edit the org-files ``remotely'' from | |
4717 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once, | |
4718 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge. | |
4719 | |
4720 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For | |
4721 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line. | |
4722 | |
4723 @table @kbd | |
4724 @tsubheading{Motion} | |
4725 @cindex motion commands in agenda | |
4726 @kindex n | |
4727 @item n | |
4728 Next line (same as @key{up}). | |
4729 @kindex p | |
4730 @item p | |
4731 Previous line (same as @key{down}). | |
4732 @tsubheading{View/GoTo org file} | |
4733 @kindex mouse-3 | |
4734 @kindex @key{SPC} | |
4735 @item mouse-3 | |
4736 @itemx @key{SPC} | |
4737 Display the original location of the item in another window. | |
4738 @c | |
4739 @kindex L | |
4740 @item L | |
4741 Display original location and recenter that window. | |
4742 @c | |
4743 @kindex mouse-2 | |
4744 @kindex mouse-1 | |
4745 @kindex @key{TAB} | |
4746 @item mouse-2 | |
4747 @itemx mouse-1 | |
4748 @itemx @key{TAB} | |
4749 Go to the original location of the item in another window. Under Emacs | |
4750 22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also works for this. | |
4751 @c | |
4752 @kindex @key{RET} | |
4753 @itemx @key{RET} | |
4754 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows. | |
4755 @c | |
4756 @kindex f | |
4757 @item f | |
4758 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through | |
4759 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding | |
4760 location in the org file. The initial setting for this mode in new | |
4761 agenda buffers can be set with the variable | |
4762 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}. | |
4763 @c | |
4764 @kindex b | |
4765 @item b | |
4766 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. | |
4767 With numerical prefix ARG, go up to this level and then take that tree. | |
4768 If ARG is negative, go up that many levels. With @kbd{C-u} prefix, do | |
4769 not remove the previously used indirect buffer. | |
4770 @c | |
4771 @kindex l | |
4772 @item l | |
4773 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that where marked DONE while | |
4774 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, | |
4775 as are entries that have been clocked on that day. | |
4776 | |
4777 @tsubheading{Change display} | |
4778 @cindex display changing, in agenda | |
4779 @kindex o | |
4780 @item o | |
4781 Delete other windows. | |
4782 @c | |
4783 @kindex d | |
4784 @kindex w | |
4785 @kindex m | |
4786 @kindex y | |
4787 @item d w m y | |
4788 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, | |
4789 this setting becomes the default for subseqent agenda commands. Since | |
4790 month and year views are slow to create, the do not become the default. | |
4791 @c | |
4792 @kindex D | |
4793 @item D | |
4794 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/Daily agenda}. | |
4795 @c | |
4796 @kindex g | |
4797 @item g | |
4798 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables | |
4799 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}. | |
4800 @c | |
4801 @kindex r | |
4802 @item r | |
4803 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes | |
4804 after modification of the time stamps of items with S-@key{left} and | |
4805 S-@key{right}. When the buffer is the global todo list, a prefix | |
4806 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO | |
4807 keyword. | |
4808 @c | |
4809 @kindex s | |
4810 @item s | |
4811 Save all Org-mode buffers in the current Emacs session. | |
4812 @c | |
4813 @kindex @key{right} | |
4814 @item @key{right} | |
4815 Display the following @code{org-agenda-ndays} days. For example, if | |
4816 the display covers a week, switch to the following week. With prefix | |
4817 arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-ndays} days. | |
4818 @c | |
4819 @kindex @key{left} | |
4820 @item @key{left} | |
4821 Display the previous dates. | |
4822 @c | |
4823 @kindex . | |
4824 @item . | |
4825 Goto today. | |
4826 | |
4827 @tsubheading{Remote editing} | |
4828 @cindex remote editing, from agenda | |
4829 | |
4830 @item 0-9 | |
4831 Digit argument. | |
4832 @c | |
4833 @cindex undoing remote-editing events | |
4834 @cindex remote editing, undo | |
4835 @kindex C-_ | |
4836 @item C-_ | |
4837 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone | |
4838 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer. | |
4839 @c | |
4840 @kindex t | |
4841 @item t | |
4842 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the | |
4843 original org file. | |
4844 @c | |
4845 @kindex C-k | |
4846 @item C-k | |
4847 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging | |
4848 to it in the original Org-mode file. If the text to be deleted remotely | |
4849 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See | |
4850 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}. | |
4851 @c | |
4852 @kindex $ | |
4853 @item $ | |
4854 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. | |
4855 @c | |
4856 @kindex T | |
4857 @item T | |
4858 Show all tags associated with the current item. Because of | |
4859 inheritance, this may be more than the tags listed in the line itself. | |
4860 @c | |
4861 @kindex : | |
4862 @item : | |
4863 Set tags for the current headline. | |
4864 @c | |
4865 @kindex a | |
4866 @item a | |
4867 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. | |
4868 @c | |
4869 @kindex , | |
4870 @item , | |
4871 Set the priority for the current item. Org-mode prompts for the | |
4872 priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the priority cookie | |
4873 is removed from the entry. | |
4874 @c | |
4875 @kindex P | |
4876 @item P | |
4877 Display weighted priority of current item. | |
4878 @c | |
4879 @kindex + | |
4880 @kindex S-@key{up} | |
4881 @item + | |
4882 @itemx S-@key{up} | |
4883 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in | |
4884 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r} | |
4885 key for this. | |
4886 @c | |
4887 @kindex - | |
4888 @kindex S-@key{down} | |
4889 @item - | |
4890 @itemx S-@key{down} | |
4891 Decrease the priority of the current item. | |
4892 @c | |
4893 @kindex C-c C-s | |
4894 @item C-c C-s | |
4895 Schedule this item | |
4896 @c | |
4897 @kindex C-c C-d | |
4898 @item C-c C-d | |
4899 Set a deadline for this item. | |
4900 @c | |
4901 @kindex S-@key{right} | |
4902 @item S-@key{right} | |
4903 Change the time stamp associated with the current line by one day into | |
4904 the future. With prefix argument, change it by that many days. For | |
4905 example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. The | |
4906 stamp is changed in the original org file, but the change is not | |
4907 directly reflected in the agenda buffer. Use the | |
4908 @kbd{r} key to update the buffer. | |
4909 @c | |
4910 @kindex S-@key{left} | |
4911 @item S-@key{left} | |
4912 Change the time stamp associated with the current line by one day | |
4913 into the past. | |
4914 @c | |
4915 @kindex > | |
4916 @item > | |
4917 Change the time stamp associated with the current line to today. | |
4918 The key @kbd{>} has been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} | |
4919 on my keyboard. | |
4920 @c | |
4921 @kindex I | |
4922 @item I | |
4923 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it | |
4924 is stopped first. | |
4925 @c | |
4926 @kindex O | |
4927 @item O | |
4928 Stop the previously started clock. | |
4929 @c | |
4930 @kindex X | |
4931 @item X | |
4932 Cancel the currently running clock. | |
4933 | |
4934 @tsubheading{Calendar commands} | |
4935 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda | |
4936 @kindex c | |
4937 @item c | |
4938 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor. | |
4939 @c | |
4940 @item c | |
4941 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org-mode agenda for the | |
4942 date at the cursor. | |
4943 @c | |
4944 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda | |
4945 @kindex i | |
4946 @item i | |
4947 Insert a new entry into the diary. Prompts for the type of entry | |
4948 (day, weekly, monthly, yearly, anniversary, cyclic) and creates a new | |
4949 entry in the diary, just as @kbd{i d} etc. would do in the calendar. | |
4950 The date is taken from the cursor position. | |
4951 @c | |
4952 @kindex M | |
4953 @item M | |
4954 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date. | |
4955 @c | |
4956 @kindex S | |
4957 @item S | |
4958 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set | |
4959 with calendar variables, see documentation of the Emacs calendar. | |
4960 @c | |
4961 @kindex C | |
4962 @item C | |
4963 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic | |
4964 calendars. | |
4965 @c | |
4966 @kindex H | |
4967 @item H | |
4968 Show holidays for three month around the cursor date. | |
4969 @c | |
4970 @c FIXME: This should be a different key. | |
4971 @kindex C-c C-x C-c | |
4972 @item C-c C-x C-c | |
4973 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files. | |
4974 | |
4975 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file} | |
4976 @kindex C-x C-w | |
4977 @item C-x C-w | |
4978 @cindex exporting agenda views | |
4979 @cindex agenda views, exporting | |
4980 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the | |
4981 selected file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension | |
4982 @file{.html} or @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), or | |
4983 plain text (any other extension). Use the variable | |
4984 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} | |
4985 and for @file{htmlize} to be used during export. | |
4986 | |
4987 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit} | |
4988 @kindex q | |
4989 @item q | |
4990 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer. | |
4991 @c | |
4992 @kindex x | |
4993 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers | |
4994 @item x | |
4995 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs | |
4996 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to | |
4997 visit org files will not be removed. | |
4998 @end table | |
4999 | |
5000 | |
5001 @node Custom agenda views, , Agenda commands, Agenda views | |
5002 @section Custom agenda views | |
5003 @cindex custom agenda views | |
5004 @cindex agenda views, custom | |
5005 | |
5006 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access | |
5007 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite | |
5008 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the | |
5009 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands. | |
5010 | |
5011 @menu | |
5012 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often | |
5013 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer | |
5014 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules | |
5015 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing agendas to files. | |
5016 * Extracting Agenda Information for other programs:: | |
5017 @end menu | |
5018 | |
5019 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views | |
5020 @subsection Storing searches | |
5021 | |
5022 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard | |
5023 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda | |
5024 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current | |
5025 buffer). | |
5026 @kindex C-c a C | |
5027 Custom commands are configured in the variable | |
5028 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for | |
5029 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with | |
5030 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid | |
5031 search types: | |
5032 | |
5033 @lisp | |
5034 @group | |
5035 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands | |
5036 '(("w" todo "WAITING") | |
5037 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING") | |
5038 ("u" tags "+BOSS-URGENT") | |
5039 ("v" tags-todo "+BOSS-URGENT") | |
5040 ("U" tags-tree "+BOSS-URGENT") | |
5041 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>"))) | |
5042 @end group | |
5043 @end lisp | |
5044 | |
5045 @noindent | |
5046 The initial single-character string in each entry defines the character | |
5047 you have to press after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to | |
5048 access the command. The second parameter is the search type, followed | |
5049 by the string or regular expression to be used for the matching. The | |
5050 example above will therefore define: | |
5051 | |
5052 @table @kbd | |
5053 @item C-c a w | |
5054 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO | |
5055 keyword | |
5056 @item C-c a W | |
5057 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the | |
5058 results as a sparse tree | |
5059 @item C-c a u | |
5060 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:BOSS:} but not | |
5061 @samp{:URGENT:} | |
5062 @item C-c a v | |
5063 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to | |
5064 headlines that are also TODO items | |
5065 @item C-c a U | |
5066 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and | |
5067 displaying the result as a sparse tree | |
5068 @item C-c a f | |
5069 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries | |
5070 containing the word @samp{FIXME}. | |
5071 @end table | |
5072 | |
5073 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views | |
5074 @subsection Block agenda | |
5075 @cindex block agenda | |
5076 @cindex agenda, with block views | |
5077 | |
5078 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise | |
5079 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in | |
5080 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the | |
5081 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo} | |
5082 for the global todo list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the | |
5083 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and | |
5084 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples: | |
5085 | |
5086 @lisp | |
5087 @group | |
5088 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands | |
5089 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks" | |
5090 ((agenda) | |
5091 (tags-todo "HOME") | |
5092 (tags "GARDEN"))) | |
5093 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks" | |
5094 ((agenda) | |
5095 (tags-todo "WORK") | |
5096 (tags "OFFICE"))))) | |
5097 @end group | |
5098 @end lisp | |
5099 | |
5100 @noindent | |
5101 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff | |
5102 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain | |
5103 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag | |
5104 @samp{HOME}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{GARDEN}. Finally the | |
5105 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks. | |
5106 | |
5107 | |
5108 @node Setting Options, Exporting Agenda Views, Block agenda, Custom agenda views | |
5109 @subsection Setting Options for custom commands | |
5110 @cindex options, for custom agenda views | |
5111 | |
5112 Org-mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction | |
5113 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda | |
5114 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change | |
5115 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting | |
5116 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the | |
5117 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example: | |
5118 | |
5119 @lisp | |
5120 @group | |
5121 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands | |
5122 '(("w" todo "WAITING" | |
5123 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down)) | |
5124 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: "))) | |
5125 ("U" tags-tree "+BOSS-URGENT" | |
5126 ((org-show-following-heading nil) | |
5127 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil))))) | |
5128 @end group | |
5129 @end lisp | |
5130 | |
5131 @noindent | |
5132 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by | |
5133 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed:} | |
5134 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of | |
5135 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the | |
5136 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match | |
5137 will be shown. | |
5138 | |
5139 For command sets creating a block agenda, | |
5140 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting | |
5141 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single | |
5142 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in | |
5143 the set. The former are just added to the command entry, the latter | |
5144 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block | |
5145 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy | |
5146 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort | |
5147 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order, | |
5148 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this: | |
5149 | |
5150 @lisp | |
5151 @group | |
5152 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands | |
5153 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks" | |
5154 ((agenda) | |
5155 (tags-todo "HOME") | |
5156 (tags "GARDEN" | |
5157 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up))))) | |
5158 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down)))) | |
5159 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks" | |
5160 ((agenda) | |
5161 (tags-todo "WORK") | |
5162 (tags "OFFICE"))))) | |
5163 @end group | |
5164 @end lisp | |
5165 | |
5166 As you see, the values and parenthesis setting is a little complex. | |
5167 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable - it | |
5168 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: When setting options in | |
5169 this interface, the @emph{values} are just lisp expressions. So if the | |
5170 value is a string, you need to add the double quotes around the value | |
5171 yourself. | |
5172 | |
5173 | |
5174 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Extracting Agenda Information for other programs, Setting Options, Custom agenda views | |
5175 @subsection Exporting Agenda Views | |
5176 @cindex agenda views, exporting | |
5177 | |
5178 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a | |
5179 printed version of some agenda views to carry around. Org-mode can | |
5180 export custom agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to | |
5181 install Hrvoje Niksic' @file{htmlize.el}.} and postscript. If you want | |
5182 to do this only occasionally, use the command | |
5183 | |
5184 @table @kbd | |
5185 @kindex C-x C-w | |
5186 @item C-x C-w | |
5187 @cindex exporting agenda views | |
5188 @cindex agenda views, exporting | |
5189 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the | |
5190 selected file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension | |
5191 @file{.html} or @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), or | |
5192 plain text (any other extension). Use the variable | |
5193 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} | |
5194 and for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example | |
5195 @lisp | |
5196 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings | |
5197 '((ps-number-of-columns 2) | |
5198 (ps-landscape-mode t) | |
5199 (htmlize-output-type 'css))) | |
5200 @end lisp | |
5201 @end table | |
5202 | |
5203 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate | |
5204 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names | |
5205 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda | |
5206 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for | |
5207 them in order to be able to specify filenames.}. Here is an example | |
5208 that first does define custom commands for the agenda and the global | |
5209 todo list, together with a number of files to which to export them. | |
5210 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify filenames for them | |
5211 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory, | |
5212 or absolute. | |
5213 | |
5214 @lisp | |
5215 @group | |
5216 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands | |
5217 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps")) | |
5218 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps")) | |
5219 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks" | |
5220 ((agenda) | |
5221 (tags-todo "HOME") | |
5222 (tags "GARDEN")) | |
5223 nil | |
5224 ("~/views/home.html")) | |
5225 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks" | |
5226 ((agenda) | |
5227 (tags-todo "WORK") | |
5228 (tags "OFFICE")) | |
5229 nil | |
5230 ("~/views/office.ps")))) | |
5231 @end group | |
5232 @end lisp | |
5233 | |
5234 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is | |
5235 @file{.html}, Org-mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert | |
5236 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is | |
5237 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce | |
5238 postscript output. Any other extension produces a plain ASCII file. | |
5239 | |
5240 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those | |
5241 commands interactively. Instead, there is a special command to produce | |
5242 @emph{all} specified files in one step: | |
5243 | |
5244 @table @kbd | |
5245 @kindex C-c a e | |
5246 @item C-c a e | |
5247 Export all agenda views that have export filenames associated with | |
5248 them. | |
5249 @end table | |
5250 | |
5251 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also | |
5252 set options for the export commands. For example: | |
5253 | |
5254 @lisp | |
5255 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands | |
5256 '(("X" agenda "" | |
5257 ((ps-number-of-columns 2) | |
5258 (ps-landscape-mode t) | |
5259 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ") | |
5260 (org-agenda-with-colors nil) | |
5261 (org-agenda-remove-tags t)) | |
5262 ("theagenda.ps")))) | |
5263 @end lisp | |
5264 | |
5265 @noindent | |
5266 This command sets two options for the postscript exporter, to make it | |
5267 print in two columns in landscape format - the resulting page can be cut | |
5268 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify | |
5269 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and | |
5270 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags | |
5271 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the | |
5272 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in | |
5273 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings | |
5274 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence. | |
5275 | |
5276 @noindent | |
5277 From the command line you may also use | |
5278 @example | |
5279 emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill | |
5280 @end example | |
5281 @noindent | |
5282 or, if you need to modify some parameters | |
5283 @example | |
5284 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \ | |
5285 org-agenda-ndays 30 \ | |
5286 org-agenda-include-diary nil \ | |
5287 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \ | |
5288 -kill | |
5289 @end example | |
5290 @noindent | |
5291 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file | |
5292 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with 30 days | |
5293 extent. | |
5294 | |
5295 @node Extracting Agenda Information for other programs, , Exporting Agenda Views, Custom agenda views | |
5296 @subsection Extracting Agenda Information for other programs | |
5297 @cindex agenda, pipe | |
5298 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing | |
5299 | |
5300 Org-mode provides commands to access agenda information for the command | |
5301 line in emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent | |
5302 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further | |
5303 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function | |
5304 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as | |
5305 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter. | |
5306 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands | |
5307 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any | |
5308 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the | |
5309 current TODO list, you could use | |
5310 | |
5311 @example | |
5312 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr | |
5313 @end example | |
5314 | |
5315 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a | |
5316 tags/todo match string. For example, to print your local shopping list | |
5317 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag | |
5318 @samp{NewYork}), you could use | |
5319 | |
5320 @example | |
5321 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \ | |
5322 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr | |
5323 @end example | |
5324 | |
5325 @noindent | |
5326 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this: | |
5327 | |
5328 @example | |
5329 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \ | |
5330 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \ | |
5331 org-agenda-ndays 30 \ | |
5332 org-agenda-include-diary nil \ | |
5333 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \ | |
5334 | lpr | |
5335 @end example | |
5336 | |
5337 @noindent | |
5338 which will produce a 30 day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file | |
5339 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary. | |
5340 | |
5341 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you | |
5342 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated | |
5343 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will | |
5344 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line | |
5345 are: | |
5346 | |
5347 @example | |
5348 category @r{The category of the item} | |
5349 head @r{The headline, without TODO kwd, TAGS and PRIORITY} | |
5350 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be} | |
5351 todo @r{selected in TODO match} | |
5352 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match} | |
5353 diary @r{imported from diary} | |
5354 deadline @r{a deadline} | |
5355 scheduled @r{scheduled} | |
5356 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp} | |
5357 closed @r{entry was closed on date} | |
5358 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline} | |
5359 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item} | |
5360 block @r{entry has date block including date} | |
5361 todo @r{The todo keyword, if any} | |
5362 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons} | |
5363 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14} | |
5364 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50} | |
5365 extra @r{String with extra planning info} | |
5366 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given} | |
5367 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority} | |
5368 @end example | |
5369 | |
5370 @noindent | |
5371 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled) | |
5372 lead to the selection of the item. | |
5373 | |
5374 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post processing script. | |
5375 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from | |
5376 Emacs/org-mode and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox: | |
5377 | |
5378 @example | |
5379 @group | |
5380 #!/usr/bin/perl | |
5381 | |
5382 # define the Emacs command to run | |
5383 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'"; | |
5384 | |
5385 # run it and capture the output | |
5386 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@}; | |
5387 | |
5388 # loop over all lines | |
5389 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{ | |
5390 | |
5391 # get the individual values | |
5392 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra, | |
5393 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line); | |
5394 | |
5395 # proccess and print | |
5396 print "[ ] $head\n"; | |
5397 @} | |
5398 @end group | |
5399 @end example | |
5400 | |
5401 @node Embedded LaTeX, Exporting, Agenda views, Top | |
5402 @chapter Embedded LaTeX | |
5403 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation | |
5404 @cindex La@TeX{} interpretation | |
5405 | |
5406 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. One | |
5407 exception, however, are scientific notes which need to be able to | |
5408 contain mathematical symbols and the occasional formula. | |
5409 La@TeX{}@footnote{La@TeX{} is a macro system based on Donald E. Knuth's | |
5410 @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as ``La@TeX{}'' are | |
5411 really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this distinction.} | |
5412 is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org-mode supports | |
5413 embedding La@TeX{} code into its files, because many academics are used | |
5414 to read La@TeX{} source code, and because it can be readily processed | |
5415 into images for HTML production. | |
5416 | |
5417 It is not necessary to mark La@TeX{} macros and code in any special way. | |
5418 If you observe a few conventions, Org-mode knows how to find it and what | |
5419 to do with it. | |
5420 | |
5421 @menu | |
5422 * Math symbols:: TeX macros for symbols and Greek letters | |
5423 * Subscripts and Superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text | |
5424 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy | |
5425 * Processing LaTeX fragments:: Previewing LaTeX processing | |
5426 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas | |
5427 @end menu | |
5428 | |
5429 @node Math symbols, Subscripts and Superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX | |
5430 @section Math symbols | |
5431 @cindex math symbols | |
5432 @cindex TeX macros | |
5433 | |
5434 You can use La@TeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} | |
5435 to indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. | |
5436 Completion for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a | |
5437 few letters, and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. | |
5438 Unlike La@TeX{} code, Org-mode allows these macros to be present | |
5439 without surrounding math delimiters, for example: | |
5440 | |
5441 @example | |
5442 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma. | |
5443 @end example | |
5444 | |
5445 During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), these symbols are translated | |
5446 into the proper syntax for HTML, for the above examples this is | |
5447 @samp{α} and @samp{→}, respectively. | |
5448 | |
5449 @node Subscripts and Superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Math symbols, Embedded LaTeX | |
5450 @section Subscripts and Superscripts | |
5451 @cindex subscript | |
5452 @cindex superscript | |
5453 | |
5454 Just like in La@TeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super- | |
5455 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in | |
5456 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is | |
5457 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts | |
5458 with curly braces. For example | |
5459 | |
5460 @example | |
5461 The mass if the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of | |
5462 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m. | |
5463 @end example | |
5464 | |
5465 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote | |
5466 @samp{^} and @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\_} and @samp{\^}. | |
5467 | |
5468 During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), subscript and superscripts | |
5469 are surrounded with @code{<sub>} and @code{<sup>} tags, respectively. | |
5470 | |
5471 @node LaTeX fragments, Processing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and Superscripts, Embedded LaTeX | |
5472 @section LaTeX fragments | |
5473 @cindex LaTeX fragments | |
5474 | |
5475 With symbols, sub- and superscripts, HTML is pretty much at its end when | |
5476 it comes to representing mathematical formulas@footnote{Yes, there is | |
5477 MathML, but that is not yet fully supported by many browsers, and there | |
5478 is no decent converter for turning La@TeX{} or ASCII representations of | |
5479 formulas into MathML. So for the time being, converting formulas into | |
5480 images seems the way to go.}. More complex expressions need a dedicated | |
5481 formula processor. To this end, Org-mode can contain arbitrary La@TeX{} | |
5482 fragments. It provides commands to preview the typeset result of these | |
5483 fragments, and upon export to HTML, all fragments will be converted to | |
5484 images and inlined into the HTML document@footnote{The La@TeX{} export | |
5485 will not use images for displaying La@TeX{} fragments but include these | |
5486 fragments directly into the La@TeX{} code.}. For this to work you | |
5487 need to be on a system with a working La@TeX{} installation. You also | |
5488 need the @file{dvipng} program, available at | |
5489 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The La@TeX{} header that | |
5490 will be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the | |
5491 variable @code{org-format-latex-header}. | |
5492 | |
5493 La@TeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following | |
5494 snippets will be identified as La@TeX{} source code: | |
5495 @itemize @bullet | |
5496 @item | |
5497 Environments of any kind. The only requirement is that the | |
5498 @code{\begin} statement appears on a new line, preceded by only | |
5499 whitespace. | |
5500 @item | |
5501 Text within the usual La@TeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with | |
5502 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized | |
5503 as math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, | |
5504 is directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in | |
5505 between, and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace or | |
5506 punctuation. For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so | |
5507 when in doubt, use @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters. | |
5508 @end itemize | |
5509 | |
5510 @noindent For example: | |
5511 | |
5512 @example | |
5513 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments, | |
5514 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures | |
5515 \end@{equation@} % etc | |
5516 | |
5517 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be | |
5518 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \]. | |
5519 @end example | |
5520 | |
5521 @noindent | |
5522 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you | |
5523 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the | |
5524 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the La@TeX{} converter. | |
5525 | |
5526 @node Processing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX | |
5527 @section Processing LaTeX fragments | |
5528 @cindex LaTeX fragments, preview | |
5529 | |
5530 La@TeX{} fragments can be processed to produce a preview images of the | |
5531 typeset expressions: | |
5532 | |
5533 @table @kbd | |
5534 @kindex C-c C-x C-l | |
5535 @item C-c C-x C-l | |
5536 Produce a preview image of the La@TeX{} fragment at point and overlay it | |
5537 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all | |
5538 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called | |
5539 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with | |
5540 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline, | |
5541 process the entire buffer. | |
5542 @kindex C-c C-c | |
5543 @item C-c C-c | |
5544 Remove the overlay preview images. | |
5545 @end table | |
5546 | |
5547 During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), all La@TeX{} fragments are | |
5548 converted into images and inlined into the document if the following | |
5549 setting is active: | |
5550 | |
5551 @lisp | |
5552 (setq org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments t) | |
5553 @end lisp | |
5554 | |
5555 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Processing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX | |
5556 @section Using CDLaTeX to enter math | |
5557 @cindex CDLaTeX | |
5558 | |
5559 CDLaTeX-mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a | |
5560 major La@TeX{} mode like AUCTeX in order to speed-up insertion of | |
5561 environments and math templates. Inside Org-mode, you can make use of | |
5562 some of the features of cdlatex-mode. You need to install | |
5563 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with | |
5564 AUCTeX) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}. | |
5565 Don't turn cdlatex-mode itself under Org-mode, but use the light | |
5566 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org-mode. Turn it | |
5567 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all | |
5568 Org-mode files with | |
5569 | |
5570 @lisp | |
5571 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex) | |
5572 @end lisp | |
5573 | |
5574 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more | |
5575 details see the documentation of cdlatex-mode): | |
5576 @itemize @bullet | |
5577 @kindex C-c @{ | |
5578 @item | |
5579 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}. | |
5580 @item | |
5581 @kindex @key{TAB} | |
5582 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a | |
5583 La@TeX{} fragment@footnote{Org-mode has a method to test if the cursor is | |
5584 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function | |
5585 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will | |
5586 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor | |
5587 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into | |
5588 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand | |
5589 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if | |
5590 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB}, | |
5591 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment. | |
5592 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}. | |
5593 @item | |
5594 @kindex _ | |
5595 @kindex ^ | |
5596 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a La@TeX{} fragment will insert these | |
5597 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move | |
5598 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or | |
5599 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable | |
5600 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}). | |
5601 @item | |
5602 @kindex ` | |
5603 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math | |
5604 macros, also outside La@TeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds | |
5605 after the backquote, a help window will pop up. | |
5606 @item | |
5607 @kindex ' | |
5608 Pressing the normal quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies | |
5609 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than | |
5610 1.5 seconds after the backquote, a help window will pop up. Character | |
5611 modification will work only inside La@TeX{} fragments, outside the quote | |
5612 is normal. | |
5613 @end itemize | |
5614 | |
5615 @node Exporting, Publishing, Embedded LaTeX, Top | |
5616 @chapter Exporting | |
5617 @cindex exporting | |
5618 | |
5619 Org-mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For | |
5620 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and | |
5621 simple version of an Org-mode file. HTML export allows you to publish a | |
5622 notes file on the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for | |
5623 exchange with a broad range of other applications. La@TeX{} export lets | |
5624 you use Org-mode and its structured editing functions to easily create | |
5625 La@TeX{} files. To incorporate entries with associated times like | |
5626 deadlines or appointments into a desktop calendar program like iCal, | |
5627 Org-mode can also produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently | |
5628 Org-mode only supports export, not import of these different formats. | |
5629 | |
5630 When exporting, Org-mode uses special conventions to enrich the output | |
5631 produced. @xref{Text interpretation}, for more details. | |
5632 | |
5633 @table @kbd | |
5634 @kindex C-c C-e | |
5635 @item C-c C-e | |
5636 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window | |
5637 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing | |
5638 command. | |
5639 @end table | |
5640 | |
5641 @menu | |
5642 * ASCII export:: Exporting to plain ASCII | |
5643 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML | |
5644 * LaTeX export:: Exporting to LaTeX | |
5645 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO | |
5646 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format | |
5647 * Text interpretation:: How the exporter looks at the file | |
5648 @end menu | |
5649 | |
5650 @node ASCII export, HTML export, Exporting, Exporting | |
5651 @section ASCII export | |
5652 @cindex ASCII export | |
5653 | |
5654 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org-mode | |
5655 file. | |
5656 | |
5657 @cindex region, active | |
5658 @cindex active region | |
5659 @cindex transient-mark-mode | |
5660 @table @kbd | |
5661 @kindex C-c C-e a | |
5662 @item C-c C-e a | |
5663 Export as ASCII file. For an org file @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file | |
5664 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without | |
5665 warning. If there is an active region, only the region will be | |
5666 exported. If the selected region is a single tree, the tree head will | |
5667 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an | |
5668 EXPORT_FILE_NAME property, that name will be used for the export. | |
5669 @kindex C-c C-e v a | |
5670 @item C-c C-e v a | |
5671 Export only the visible part of the document. | |
5672 @end table | |
5673 | |
5674 @cindex headline levels, for exporting | |
5675 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become | |
5676 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels | |
5677 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur | |
5678 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example, | |
5679 | |
5680 @example | |
5681 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a} | |
5682 @end example | |
5683 | |
5684 @noindent | |
5685 creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When | |
5686 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following | |
5687 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with | |
5688 the assumption that the first bodyline indicates the base indentation of | |
5689 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve | |
5690 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less | |
5691 indentation than the first, these are left alone. | |
5692 | |
5693 @node HTML export, LaTeX export, ASCII export, Exporting | |
5694 @section HTML export | |
5695 @cindex HTML export | |
5696 | |
5697 Org-mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive | |
5698 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Grubers @emph{markdown} | |
5699 language, but with additional support for tables. | |
5700 | |
5701 @menu | |
5702 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke LaTeX export | |
5703 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode | |
5704 * Links:: Transformation of links for HTML | |
5705 * Images:: How to include images | |
5706 * CSS support:: Changing the appearence of the output | |
5707 @end menu | |
5708 | |
5709 @node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export | |
5710 @subsection HTML export commands | |
5711 | |
5712 @cindex region, active | |
5713 @cindex active region | |
5714 @cindex transient-mark-mode | |
5715 @table @kbd | |
5716 @kindex C-c C-e h | |
5717 @item C-c C-e h | |
5718 Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an org file | |
5719 @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file | |
5720 will be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region, only | |
5721 the region will be exported. If the selected region is a single tree, | |
5722 the tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry | |
5723 has or inherits an EXPORT_FILE_NAME property, that name will be used for | |
5724 the export. | |
5725 @kindex C-c C-e b | |
5726 @item C-c C-e b | |
5727 Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser. | |
5728 @kindex C-c C-e H | |
5729 @item C-c C-e H | |
5730 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file. | |
5731 @kindex C-c C-e R | |
5732 @item C-c C-e H | |
5733 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With prefix arg, do not | |
5734 produce file header and foot, but just the plain HTML section for the | |
5735 region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations. | |
5736 @kindex C-c C-e v h | |
5737 @kindex C-c C-e v b | |
5738 @kindex C-c C-e v H | |
5739 @kindex C-c C-e v R | |
5740 @item C-c C-e v h | |
5741 @item C-c C-e v b | |
5742 @item C-c C-e v H | |
5743 @item C-c C-e v R | |
5744 Export only the visible part of the document. | |
5745 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html | |
5746 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was org-mode | |
5747 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any | |
5748 buffer. | |
5749 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML | |
5750 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by HTML | |
5751 code. | |
5752 @end table | |
5753 | |
5754 @cindex headline levels, for exporting | |
5755 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become | |
5756 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels | |
5757 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur | |
5758 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example, | |
5759 | |
5760 @example | |
5761 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b} | |
5762 @end example | |
5763 | |
5764 @noindent | |
5765 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items. | |
5766 | |
5767 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links, HTML Export commands, HTML export | |
5768 @subsection Quoting HTML tags | |
5769 | |
5770 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and | |
5771 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags | |
5772 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in | |
5773 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for | |
5774 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to | |
5775 the exported file use either | |
5776 | |
5777 @example | |
5778 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export | |
5779 @end example | |
5780 | |
5781 @noindent or | |
5782 | |
5783 @example | |
5784 #+BEGIN_HTML | |
5785 All lines between these markers are exported literally | |
5786 #+END_HTML | |
5787 @end example | |
5788 | |
5789 | |
5790 @node Links, Images, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export | |
5791 @subsection Links | |
5792 | |
5793 @cindex links, in HTML export | |
5794 @cindex internal links, in HTML export | |
5795 @cindex external links, in HTML export | |
5796 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML | |
5797 files only if they match a dedicated @samp{<<target>>}. Automatic links | |
5798 created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio targets}) will also work in the | |
5799 HTML file. Links to external files will still work if the HTML file is | |
5800 in the same directory as the Org-mode file. Links to other @file{.org} | |
5801 files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption that an | |
5802 HTML version also exists of the linked file. For information related to | |
5803 linking files while publishing them to a publishing directory see | |
5804 @ref{Publishing links}. | |
5805 | |
5806 @node Images, CSS support, Links, HTML export | |
5807 @subsection Images | |
5808 | |
5809 @cindex images, inline in HTML | |
5810 @cindex inlining images in HTML | |
5811 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org-mode file, and | |
5812 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By | |
5813 default@footnote{but see the variable | |
5814 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}}, images are inlined if a link does | |
5815 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined, | |
5816 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link | |
5817 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part | |
5818 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an | |
5819 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the | |
5820 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that | |
5821 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use: | |
5822 | |
5823 @example | |
5824 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]] | |
5825 @end example | |
5826 | |
5827 @noindent | |
5828 and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well. | |
5829 | |
5830 @node CSS support, , Images, HTML export | |
5831 @subsection CSS support | |
5832 | |
5833 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML | |
5834 exporter assigns the following CSS classes to appropriate parts of the | |
5835 document - your style specifications may change these: | |
5836 @example | |
5837 .todo @r{TODO keywords} | |
5838 .done @r{the DONE keyword} | |
5839 .timestamp @r{time stamp} | |
5840 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a time stamp, like SCHEDULED} | |
5841 .tag @r{tag in a headline} | |
5842 .target @r{target for links} | |
5843 @end example | |
5844 | |
5845 The default style specification can be configured through the option | |
5846 @code{org-export-html-style}. If you want to use a file-local style, | |
5847 you may use file variables, best wrapped into a COMMENT section at the | |
5848 end of the outline tree. For example@footnote{Under Emacs 21, the | |
5849 continuation lines for a variable value should have no @samp{#} at the | |
5850 start of the line.}: | |
5851 | |
5852 @example | |
5853 * COMMENT html style specifications | |
5854 | |
5855 # Local Variables: | |
5856 # org-export-html-style: " <style type=\"text/css\"> | |
5857 # p @{font-weight: normal; color: gray; @} | |
5858 # h1 @{color: black; @} | |
5859 # </style>" | |
5860 # End: | |
5861 @end example | |
5862 | |
5863 Remember to execute @kbd{M-x normal-mode} after changing this to make | |
5864 the new style visible to Emacs. This command restarts org-mode for the | |
5865 current buffer and forces Emacs to re-evaluate the local variables | |
5866 section in the buffer. | |
5867 | |
5868 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles | |
5869 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets. | |
5870 | |
5871 @node LaTeX export, XOXO export, HTML export, Exporting | |
5872 @section LaTeX export | |
5873 @cindex LaTeX export | |
5874 | |
5875 Org-mode contains a La@TeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. | |
5876 | |
5877 @menu | |
5878 * LaTeX export commands:: How to invoke LaTeX export | |
5879 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal LaTeX code | |
5880 @end menu | |
5881 | |
5882 @node LaTeX export commands, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX export, LaTeX export | |
5883 @subsection LaTeX export commands | |
5884 | |
5885 @table @kbd | |
5886 @kindex C-c C-e l | |
5887 @item C-c C-e l | |
5888 Export as La@TeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. | |
5889 @kindex C-c C-e L | |
5890 @item C-c C-e L | |
5891 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file. | |
5892 @kindex C-c C-e v l | |
5893 @kindex C-c C-e v L | |
5894 @item C-c C-e v l | |
5895 @item C-c C-e v L | |
5896 Export only the visible part of the document. | |
5897 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex | |
5898 Convert the region to La@TeX{} under the assumption that it was org-mode | |
5899 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any | |
5900 buffer. | |
5901 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex | |
5902 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by La@TeX{} | |
5903 code. | |
5904 @end table | |
5905 | |
5906 @cindex headline levels, for exporting | |
5907 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become | |
5908 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels | |
5909 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or | |
5910 convert them to a custom string depending on | |
5911 @code{org-latex-low-levels}. | |
5912 | |
5913 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it | |
5914 with a prefix argument. For example, | |
5915 | |
5916 @example | |
5917 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l} | |
5918 @end example | |
5919 | |
5920 @noindent | |
5921 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items. | |
5922 | |
5923 @node Quoting LaTeX code, , LaTeX export commands, LaTeX export | |
5924 @subsection Quoting LaTeX code | |
5925 | |
5926 Embedded La@TeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX} will be correctly | |
5927 inserted into the La@TeX{} file. Forthermore, you can add special code | |
5928 that should only be present in La@TeX{} export with the following | |
5929 constructs: | |
5930 | |
5931 @example | |
5932 #+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export | |
5933 @end example | |
5934 | |
5935 @noindent or | |
5936 | |
5937 @example | |
5938 #+BEGIN_LaTeX | |
5939 All lines between these markers are exported literally | |
5940 #+END_LaTeX | |
5941 @end example | |
5942 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, LaTeX export, Exporting | |
5943 @section XOXO export | |
5944 @cindex XOXO export | |
5945 | |
5946 Org-mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output. | |
5947 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and | |
5948 does not interpret any additional Org-mode features. | |
5949 | |
5950 @table @kbd | |
5951 @kindex C-c C-e x | |
5952 @item C-c C-e x | |
5953 Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}. | |
5954 @kindex C-c C-e v | |
5955 @item C-c C-e v x | |
5956 Export only the visible part of the document. | |
5957 @end table | |
5958 | |
5959 @node iCalendar export, Text interpretation, XOXO export, Exporting | |
5960 @section iCalendar export | |
5961 @cindex iCalendar export | |
5962 | |
5963 Some people like to use Org-mode for keeping track of projects, but | |
5964 still prefer a standard calendar application for anniversaries and | |
5965 appointments. In this case it can be useful to have deadlines and | |
5966 other time-stamped items in Org-mode files show up in the calendar | |
5967 application. Org-mode can export calendar information in the standard | |
5968 iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries included in the | |
5969 export, configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. | |
5970 | |
5971 @table @kbd | |
5972 @kindex C-c C-e i | |
5973 @item C-c C-e i | |
5974 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same | |
5975 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}. | |
5976 @kindex C-c C-e I | |
5977 @item C-c C-e I | |
5978 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in | |
5979 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar | |
5980 file will be written. | |
5981 @kindex C-c C-e c | |
5982 @item C-c C-e c | |
5983 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in | |
5984 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by | |
5985 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}. | |
5986 @end table | |
5987 | |
5988 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application | |
5989 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue. | |
5990 | |
5991 | |
5992 @node Text interpretation, , iCalendar export, Exporting | |
5993 @section Text interpretation by the exporter | |
5994 | |
5995 The exporter backends interpret additional structure in the Org-mode file | |
5996 in order to produce better output. | |
5997 | |
5998 @menu | |
5999 * Comment lines:: Some lines will not be exported | |
6000 * Initial text:: Text before the first headline | |
6001 * Footnotes:: Numbers like [1] | |
6002 * Enhancing text:: Subscripts, symbols and more | |
6003 * Export options:: How to influence the export settings | |
6004 @end menu | |
6005 | |
6006 @node Comment lines, Initial text, Text interpretation, Text interpretation | |
6007 @subsection Comment lines | |
6008 @cindex comment lines | |
6009 @cindex exporting, not | |
6010 | |
6011 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments | |
6012 and will never be exported. Also entire subtrees starting with the | |
6013 word @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. | |
6014 | |
6015 @table @kbd | |
6016 @kindex C-c ; | |
6017 @item C-c ; | |
6018 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry. | |
6019 @end table | |
6020 | |
6021 @node Initial text, Footnotes, Comment lines, Text interpretation | |
6022 @subsection Text before the first headline | |
6023 | |
6024 Org-mode normally ignores any text before the first headline when | |
6025 exporting, leaving this region for internal links to speed up navigation | |
6026 etc. However, in publishing-oriented files, you might want to have some | |
6027 text before the first headline, like a small introduction, special HTML | |
6028 code with a navigation bar, etc. You can ask to have this part of the | |
6029 file exported as well by setting the variable | |
6030 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{nil}. On a | |
6031 per-file basis, you can get the same effect with | |
6032 | |
6033 @example | |
6034 #+OPTIONS: skip:nil | |
6035 @end example | |
6036 | |
6037 The text before the first headline will be fully processed | |
6038 (@pxref{Enhancing text}), and the first non-comment line becomes the | |
6039 title of the exported document. If you need to include literal HTML, | |
6040 use the special constructs described in @ref{Quoting HTML tags}. The | |
6041 table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first | |
6042 headline of the file. If you would like to get it to a different | |
6043 location, insert the string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by | |
6044 itself at the desired location. | |
6045 | |
6046 Finally, if you want to use the space before the first headline for | |
6047 internal purposes, but @emph{still} want to place something before the | |
6048 first headline when exporting the file, you can use the @code{#+TEXT} | |
6049 construct: | |
6050 | |
6051 @example | |
6052 #+OPTIONS: skip:t | |
6053 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline. | |
6054 #+TEXT: We place the table of contents here: | |
6055 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS] | |
6056 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline | |
6057 @end example | |
6058 | |
6059 @node Footnotes, Enhancing text, Initial text, Text interpretation | |
6060 @subsection Footnotes | |
6061 @cindex footnotes | |
6062 @cindex @file{footnote.el} | |
6063 | |
6064 Numbers in square brackets are treated as footnotes, so that you can use | |
6065 the Emacs package @file{footnote.el} to create footnotes. For example: | |
6066 | |
6067 @example | |
6068 The org-mode homepage[1] clearly needs help from | |
6069 a good web designer. | |
6070 | |
6071 [1] The link is: http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/org | |
6072 @end example | |
6073 | |
6074 @noindent | |
6075 @kindex C-c ! | |
6076 Note that the @file{footnote} package uses @kbd{C-c !} to invoke its | |
6077 commands. This binding conflicts with the org-mode command for | |
6078 inserting inactive time stamps. You could use the variable | |
6079 @code{footnote-prefix} to switch footnotes commands to another key. Or, | |
6080 if you are too used to this binding, you could use | |
6081 @code{org-replace-disputed-keys} and @code{org-disputed-keys} to change | |
6082 the settings in Org-mode. | |
6083 | |
6084 @node Enhancing text, Export options, Footnotes, Text interpretation | |
6085 @subsection Enhancing text for export | |
6086 @cindex enhancing text | |
6087 @cindex richer text | |
6088 | |
6089 Some of the export backends of Org-mode allow for sophisticated text | |
6090 formatting, this is true in particular for the HTML and La@TeX{} | |
6091 backends. Org-mode has a number of typing conventions that allow to | |
6092 produce a richly formatted output. | |
6093 | |
6094 @itemize @bullet | |
6095 | |
6096 @cindex hand-formatted lists | |
6097 @cindex lists, hand-formatted | |
6098 @item | |
6099 Plain lists @samp{-}, @samp{*} or @samp{+} as bullet, or with @samp{1.} | |
6100 or @samp{2)} as enumerator will be recognized and transformed if the | |
6101 backend supports lists. See @xref{Plain lists}. | |
6102 | |
6103 @cindex underlined text | |
6104 @cindex bold text | |
6105 @cindex italic text | |
6106 @item | |
6107 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, | |
6108 @code{=code=}, and even @samp{+strikethrough+}@footnote{but remember | |
6109 that strikethrough is typographically evil and should @i{never} be | |
6110 used.}. | |
6111 | |
6112 @cindex horizontal rules, in exported files | |
6113 @item | |
6114 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be | |
6115 exported as a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML). | |
6116 | |
6117 @cindex LaTeX fragments, export | |
6118 @cindex TeX macros, export | |
6119 @item | |
6120 Many @TeX{} macros and entire La@TeX{} fragments are converted into HTML | |
6121 entities or images (@pxref{Embedded LaTeX}). | |
6122 | |
6123 @cindex tables, export | |
6124 @item | |
6125 Tables are transformed into native tables under the exporter, if the | |
6126 export backend supports this. Data fields before the first horizontal | |
6127 separator line will be formatted as table header fields. | |
6128 | |
6129 @cindex fixed width | |
6130 @item | |
6131 If a headline starts with the word @samp{QUOTE}, the text below the | |
6132 headline will be typeset as fixed-width, to allow quoting of computer | |
6133 codes etc. Lines starting with @samp{:} are also typeset in fixed-width | |
6134 font. | |
6135 @table @kbd | |
6136 @kindex C-c : | |
6137 @item C-c : | |
6138 Toggle fixed-width for entry (QUOTE) or region, see below. | |
6139 @end table | |
6140 | |
6141 @cindex linebreak, forced | |
6142 @item | |
6143 A double backslash @emph{at the end of a line} enforces a line break at | |
6144 this position. | |
6145 @end itemize | |
6146 | |
6147 If these conversions conflict with your habits of typing ASCII text, | |
6148 they can all be turned off with corresponding variables. See the | |
6149 customization group @code{org-export-general}, and the following section | |
6150 which explains how to set export options with special lines in a | |
6151 buffer. | |
6152 | |
6153 | |
6154 @node Export options, , Enhancing text, Text interpretation | |
6155 @subsection Export options | |
6156 @cindex options, for export | |
6157 | |
6158 @cindex completion, of option keywords | |
6159 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide | |
6160 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file. | |
6161 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c | |
6162 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is | |
6163 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion | |
6164 (@pxref{Completion}). | |
6165 | |
6166 @table @kbd | |
6167 @kindex C-c C-e t | |
6168 @item C-c C-e t | |
6169 Insert template with export options, see example below. | |
6170 @end table | |
6171 | |
6172 @example | |
6173 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name) | |
6174 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name}) | |
6175 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address}) | |
6176 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language}) | |
6177 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning. | |
6178 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given. | |
6179 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ... | |
6180 @end example | |
6181 | |
6182 @noindent | |
6183 The OPTIONS line is a compact form to specify export settings. Here | |
6184 you can: | |
6185 @cindex headline levels | |
6186 @cindex section-numbers | |
6187 @cindex table of contents | |
6188 @cindex linebreak preservation | |
6189 @cindex quoted HTML tags | |
6190 @cindex fixed-width sections | |
6191 @cindex tables | |
6192 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts | |
6193 @cindex footnotes | |
6194 @cindex emphasized text | |
6195 @cindex @TeX{} macros | |
6196 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments | |
6197 @cindex author info, in export | |
6198 @cindex time info, in export | |
6199 @example | |
6200 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export} | |
6201 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers} | |
6202 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)} | |
6203 \n: @r{turn on/off linebreak-preservation} | |
6204 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags} | |
6205 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections} | |
6206 |: @r{turn on/off tables} | |
6207 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If} | |
6208 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but} | |
6209 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.} | |
6210 f: @r{turn on/off foototes like this[1].} | |
6211 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)} | |
6212 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text} | |
6213 LaTeX: @r{turn on/off La@TeX{} fragments} | |
6214 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading} | |
6215 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file} | |
6216 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file} | |
6217 @end example | |
6218 | |
6219 These options take effect in both the HTML and La@TeX{} export, except | |
6220 for @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and | |
6221 @code{nil} for the La@TeX{} export. | |
6222 | |
6223 @node Publishing, Miscellaneous, Exporting, Top | |
6224 @chapter Publishing | |
6225 @cindex publishing | |
6226 | |
6227 Org-mode includes@footnote{@file{org-publish.el} is not distributed with | |
6228 Emacs 21, if you are still using Emacs 21, you need you need to download | |
6229 this file separately.} a publishing management system that allows you to | |
6230 configure automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of | |
6231 interlinked org files. This system is called @emph{org-publish}. You can | |
6232 also configure org-publish to automatically upload your exported HTML | |
6233 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to | |
6234 a web server. Org-publish turns org-mode into a web-site authoring tool. | |
6235 | |
6236 You can also use Org-publish to convert files into La@TeX{}, or even | |
6237 combine HTML and La@TeX{} conversion so that files are available in both | |
6238 formats on the server@footnote{Since La@TeX{} files on a server are not | |
6239 that helpful, you surely want to perform further conversion on them -- | |
6240 e.g. convert them to @code{PDF} format.}. | |
6241 | |
6242 Org-publish has been contributed to Org-mode by David O'Toole. | |
6243 | |
6244 @menu | |
6245 * Configuration:: Defining projects | |
6246 * Sample configuration:: Example projects | |
6247 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands | |
6248 @end menu | |
6249 | |
6250 @node Configuration, Sample configuration, Publishing, Publishing | |
6251 @section Configuration | |
6252 | |
6253 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination | |
6254 and many other properties of a project. | |
6255 | |
6256 @menu | |
6257 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable | |
6258 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there | |
6259 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project? | |
6260 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing | |
6261 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export | |
6262 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing? | |
6263 * Project page index:: Publishing a list of project files | |
6264 @end menu | |
6265 | |
6266 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration | |
6267 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist} | |
6268 @cindex org-publish-project-alist | |
6269 @cindex projects, for publishing | |
6270 | |
6271 Org-publish is configured almost entirely through setting the value of | |
6272 one variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. | |
6273 Each element of the list configures one project, and may be in one of | |
6274 the two following forms: | |
6275 | |
6276 @lisp | |
6277 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...) | |
6278 | |
6279 @r{or} | |
6280 | |
6281 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...)) | |
6282 | |
6283 @end lisp | |
6284 | |
6285 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. | |
6286 A project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as | |
6287 the publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When | |
6288 a project takes the second form listed above, the individual members | |
6289 of the ``components'' property are taken to be components of the | |
6290 project, which group together files requiring different publishing | |
6291 options. When you publish such a ``meta-project'' all the components | |
6292 will also publish. | |
6293 | |
6294 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration | |
6295 @subsection Sources and destinations for files | |
6296 @cindex directories, for publishing | |
6297 | |
6298 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In | |
6299 particular, org-publish needs to know where to look for source files, | |
6300 and where to put published files. | |
6301 | |
6302 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7 | |
6303 @item @code{:base-directory} | |
6304 @tab Directory containing publishing source files | |
6305 @item @code{:publishing-directory} | |
6306 @tab Directory (possibly remote) where output files will be published. | |
6307 @item @code{:preparation-function} | |
6308 @tab Function called before starting publishing process, for example to | |
6309 run @code{make} for updating files to be published. | |
6310 @end multitable | |
6311 @noindent | |
6312 | |
6313 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration | |
6314 @subsection Selecting files | |
6315 @cindex files, selecting for publishing | |
6316 | |
6317 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory | |
6318 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the | |
6319 properties | |
6320 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75 | |
6321 @item @code{:base-extension} | |
6322 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a | |
6323 regular expression. | |
6324 | |
6325 @item @code{:exclude} | |
6326 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be | |
6327 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their | |
6328 extension. | |
6329 | |
6330 @item @code{:include} | |
6331 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension} | |
6332 and @code{:exclude}. | |
6333 @end multitable | |
6334 | |
6335 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration | |
6336 @subsection Publishing Action | |
6337 @cindex action, for publishing | |
6338 | |
6339 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and | |
6340 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to | |
6341 export Org-mode files as HTML files, and this is done by the function | |
6342 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter | |
6343 (@pxref{HTML export}). But you also can publish your files in La@TeX{} by | |
6344 using the function @code{org-publish-org-to-latex} instead. Other files | |
6345 like images only need to be copied to the publishing destination. For | |
6346 non-Org-mode files, you need to specify the publishing function. | |
6347 | |
6348 | |
6349 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7 | |
6350 @item @code{:publishing-function} | |
6351 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a | |
6352 list of functions, which will all be called in turn. | |
6353 @end multitable | |
6354 | |
6355 The function must accept two arguments: a property list containing at | |
6356 least a @code{:publishing-directory} property, and the name of the file | |
6357 to be published. It should take the specified file, make the necessary | |
6358 transformation (if any) and place the result into the destination folder. | |
6359 You can write your own publishing function, but @code{org-publish} | |
6360 provides one for attachments (files that only need to be copied): | |
6361 @code{org-publish-attachment}. | |
6362 | |
6363 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration | |
6364 @subsection Options for the HTML/LaTeX exporters | |
6365 @cindex options, for publishing | |
6366 | |
6367 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML | |
6368 and La@TeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user | |
6369 variables in Org-mode. The table below lists these properties along | |
6370 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the | |
6371 respective variable for details. | |
6372 | |
6373 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7 | |
6374 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language} | |
6375 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels} | |
6376 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers} | |
6377 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc} | |
6378 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees} | |
6379 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize} | |
6380 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} | |
6381 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros} | |
6382 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments} | |
6383 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width} | |
6384 @item @code{:timestamps} .@tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps} | |
6385 @item @code{:tags} .@tab @code{org-export-with-tags} | |
6386 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables} | |
6387 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line} | |
6388 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style} | |
6389 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html} | |
6390 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images} | |
6391 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand} | |
6392 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp} | |
6393 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory} | |
6394 @item @code{:preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble} | |
6395 @item @code{:postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble} | |
6396 @item @code{:auto-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-preamble} | |
6397 @item @code{:auto-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-postamble} | |
6398 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name} | |
6399 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} | |
6400 @end multitable | |
6401 | |
6402 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in | |
6403 both HTML and La@TeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and | |
6404 @code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the | |
6405 La@TeX{} export. | |
6406 | |
6407 When a property is given a value in org-publish-project-alist, its | |
6408 setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if any) | |
6409 during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export | |
6410 options}), however, override everything. | |
6411 | |
6412 @node Publishing links, Project page index, Publishing options, Configuration | |
6413 @subsection Links between published files | |
6414 @cindex links, publishing | |
6415 | |
6416 To create a link from one Org-mode file to another, you would use | |
6417 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply | |
6418 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). Upon publishing this link | |
6419 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the | |
6420 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when | |
6421 you publish them to HTML. | |
6422 | |
6423 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are | |
6424 careful with relative pathnames, and provided you have also configured | |
6425 org-publish to upload the related files, these links will work | |
6426 too. @ref{Complex example} for an example of this usage. | |
6427 | |
6428 Sometime an Org-mode file to be published may contain links that are | |
6429 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing | |
6430 location. In this case, use the property | |
6431 | |
6432 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6 | |
6433 @item @code{:link-validation-function} | |
6434 @tab Function to validate links | |
6435 @end multitable | |
6436 | |
6437 @noindent | |
6438 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must | |
6439 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which | |
6440 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this | |
6441 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a | |
6442 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this | |
6443 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given | |
6444 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}. | |
6445 | |
6446 @node Project page index, , Publishing links, Configuration | |
6447 @subsection Project page index | |
6448 @cindex index, of published pages | |
6449 | |
6450 The following properties may be used to control publishing of an | |
6451 index of files or summary page for a given project. | |
6452 | |
6453 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75 | |
6454 @item @code{:auto-index} | |
6455 @tab When non-nil, publish an index during org-publish-current-project or | |
6456 org-publish-all. | |
6457 | |
6458 @item @code{:index-filename} | |
6459 @tab Filename for output of index. Defaults to @file{index.org} (which | |
6460 becomes @file{index.html}). | |
6461 | |
6462 @item @code{:index-title} | |
6463 @tab Title of index page. Defaults to name of file. | |
6464 | |
6465 @item @code{:index-function} | |
6466 @tab Plugin function to use for generation of index. | |
6467 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-index}, which generates a plain list | |
6468 of links to all files in the project. | |
6469 @end multitable | |
6470 | |
6471 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Configuration, Publishing | |
6472 @section Sample configuration | |
6473 | |
6474 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple | |
6475 project publishing only a set of Org-mode files. The second example is | |
6476 more complex, with a multi-component project. | |
6477 | |
6478 @menu | |
6479 * Simple example:: One-component publishing | |
6480 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example | |
6481 @end menu | |
6482 | |
6483 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration | |
6484 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration | |
6485 | |
6486 This example publishes a set of Org-mode files to the @file{public_html} | |
6487 directory on the local machine. | |
6488 | |
6489 @lisp | |
6490 (setq org-publish-project-alist | |
6491 '(("org" | |
6492 :base-directory "~/org/" | |
6493 :publishing-directory "~/public_html" | |
6494 :section-numbers nil | |
6495 :table-of-contents nil | |
6496 :style "<link rel=stylesheet | |
6497 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" | |
6498 type=\"text/css\">"))) | |
6499 @end lisp | |
6500 | |
6501 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration | |
6502 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration | |
6503 | |
6504 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including | |
6505 org files converted to HTML, image files, emacs lisp source code, and | |
6506 stylesheets. The publishing-directory is remote and private files are | |
6507 excluded. | |
6508 | |
6509 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate | |
6510 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file | |
6511 paths. For example, if your org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your | |
6512 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you'd link to an image with | |
6513 @c | |
6514 @example | |
6515 file:../images/myimage.png | |
6516 @end example | |
6517 @c | |
6518 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the | |
6519 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the | |
6520 right place on the webserver, and publishing images to it. | |
6521 | |
6522 @lisp | |
6523 (setq org-publish-project-alist | |
6524 '(("orgfiles" | |
6525 :base-directory "~/org/" | |
6526 :base-extension "org" | |
6527 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/" | |
6528 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html | |
6529 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp | |
6530 :headline-levels 3 | |
6531 :section-numbers nil | |
6532 :table-of-contents nil | |
6533 :style "<link rel=stylesheet | |
6534 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\">" | |
6535 :auto-preamble t | |
6536 :auto-postamble nil) | |
6537 | |
6538 ("images" | |
6539 :base-directory "~/images/" | |
6540 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png" | |
6541 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/" | |
6542 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment) | |
6543 | |
6544 ("other" | |
6545 :base-directory "~/other/" | |
6546 :base-extension "css\\|el" | |
6547 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/" | |
6548 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment) | |
6549 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other")))) | |
6550 @end lisp | |
6551 | |
6552 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing | |
6553 @section Triggering publication | |
6554 | |
6555 Once org-publish is properly configured, you can publish with the | |
6556 following functions: | |
6557 | |
6558 @table @kbd | |
6559 @item C-c C-e C | |
6560 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it. | |
6561 @item C-c C-e P | |
6562 Publish the project containing the current file. | |
6563 @item C-c C-e F | |
6564 Publish only the current file. | |
6565 @item C-c C-e A | |
6566 Publish all projects. | |
6567 @end table | |
6568 | |
6569 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above | |
6570 functions normally only publish changed files. You can override this and | |
6571 force publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument. | |
6572 | |
6573 @node Miscellaneous, Extensions and Hacking, Publishing, Top | |
6574 @chapter Miscellaneous | |
6575 | |
6576 @menu | |
6577 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need | |
6578 * Customization:: Adapting Org-mode to your taste | |
6579 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS | |
6580 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c | |
6581 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline | |
6582 * TTY keys:: Using Org-mode on a tty | |
6583 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages | |
6584 * Bugs:: Things which do not work perfectly | |
6585 @end menu | |
6586 | |
6587 @node Completion, Customization, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous | |
6588 @section Completion | |
6589 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols | |
6590 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords | |
6591 @cindex completion, of dictionary words | |
6592 @cindex completion, of option keywords | |
6593 @cindex completion, of tags | |
6594 @cindex completion, of property keys | |
6595 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations | |
6596 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion | |
6597 @cindex TODO keywords completion | |
6598 @cindex dictionary word completion | |
6599 @cindex option keyword completion | |
6600 @cindex tag completion | |
6601 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of | |
6602 | |
6603 Org-mode supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does | |
6604 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into | |
6605 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there. | |
6606 | |
6607 @table @kbd | |
6608 @kindex M-@key{TAB} | |
6609 @item M-@key{TAB} | |
6610 Complete word at point | |
6611 @itemize @bullet | |
6612 @item | |
6613 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords. | |
6614 @item | |
6615 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter. | |
6616 @item | |
6617 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they | |
6618 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}. | |
6619 @item | |
6620 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken | |
6621 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the | |
6622 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created | |
6623 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer. | |
6624 @item | |
6625 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list | |
6626 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current | |
6627 buffer. | |
6628 @item | |
6629 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). | |
6630 @item | |
6631 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or | |
6632 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org-mode. When the | |
6633 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again | |
6634 will insert example settings for this keyword. | |
6635 @item | |
6636 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords, | |
6637 i.e. valid keys for this line. | |
6638 @item | |
6639 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using ispell. | |
6640 @end itemize | |
6641 @end table | |
6642 | |
6643 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Completion, Miscellaneous | |
6644 @section Customization | |
6645 @cindex customization | |
6646 @cindex options, for customization | |
6647 @cindex variables, for customization | |
6648 | |
6649 There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize | |
6650 Org-mode. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not | |
6651 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization | |
6652 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select | |
6653 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many | |
6654 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special | |
6655 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}). | |
6656 | |
6657 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous | |
6658 @section Summary of in-buffer settings | |
6659 @cindex in-buffer settings | |
6660 @cindex special keywords | |
6661 | |
6662 Org-mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a | |
6663 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a | |
6664 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several | |
6665 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple | |
6666 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout | |
6667 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the | |
6668 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to | |
6669 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only | |
6670 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session. | |
6671 | |
6672 @table @kbd | |
6673 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done:: | |
6674 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for | |
6675 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end | |
6676 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it. | |
6677 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}. | |
6678 @item #+CATEGORY: | |
6679 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies | |
6680 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the | |
6681 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it. | |
6682 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM ..... | |
6683 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when | |
6684 columns view is invoked in location where no COLUMNS property applies. | |
6685 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ... | |
6686 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This | |
6687 line set the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}. | |
6688 The global version of theis variable is | |
6689 @code{org-table-formula-constants}. | |
6690 corresponding | |
6691 @item #+LINK: linkword replace | |
6692 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations. | |
6693 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is | |
6694 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}. | |
6695 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default | |
6696 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three | |
6697 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must | |
6698 have a lower ASCII number that the lowest priority. | |
6699 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value | |
6700 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current | |
6701 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property. | |
6702 @item #+STARTUP: | |
6703 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org-mode, when an | |
6704 Org-mode file is being visited. The first set of options deals with the | |
6705 initial visibility of the outline tree. The corresponding variable for | |
6706 global default settings is @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default | |
6707 value @code{t}, which means @code{overview}. | |
6708 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword | |
6709 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword | |
6710 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword | |
6711 @example | |
6712 overview @r{top-level headlines only} | |
6713 content @r{all headlines} | |
6714 showall @r{no folding at all, show everything} | |
6715 @end example | |
6716 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This | |
6717 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding | |
6718 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value | |
6719 @code{nil}. | |
6720 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword | |
6721 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword | |
6722 @example | |
6723 align @r{align all tables} | |
6724 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup} | |
6725 @end example | |
6726 Logging TODO state changes and clock intervals (variable | |
6727 @code{org-log-done}) can be configured using these options. | |
6728 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword | |
6729 @cindex @code{nologging}, STARTUP keyword | |
6730 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword | |
6731 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword | |
6732 @cindex @code{lognotestate}, STARTUP keyword | |
6733 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword | |
6734 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword | |
6735 @example | |
6736 logging @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE} | |
6737 nologging @r{don't record when items are marked DONE} | |
6738 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE} | |
6739 lognotestate @r{record timestamp and a note when TODO state changes} | |
6740 logrepeat @r{record a note when re-instating a repeating item} | |
6741 nologrepeat @r{do not record when re-instating repeating item} | |
6742 lognoteclock-out @r{record timestamp and a note when clocking out} | |
6743 @end example | |
6744 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings. The | |
6745 corresponding variables are @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and | |
6746 @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a default setting @code{nil} | |
6747 (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}). | |
6748 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword | |
6749 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword | |
6750 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword | |
6751 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword | |
6752 @example | |
6753 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.} | |
6754 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline} | |
6755 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)} | |
6756 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels} | |
6757 @end example | |
6758 To turn on custom format overlays over time stamps (variables | |
6759 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and | |
6760 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use | |
6761 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword | |
6762 @example | |
6763 customtime @r{overlay custom time format} | |
6764 @end example | |
6765 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable | |
6766 @code{constants-unit-system}). | |
6767 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword | |
6768 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword | |
6769 @example | |
6770 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system} | |
6771 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system} | |
6772 @end example | |
6773 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2) | |
6774 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the legal tags in | |
6775 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection} | |
6776 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}. | |
6777 @item #+TBLFM: | |
6778 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line. | |
6779 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+OPTIONS: | |
6780 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see | |
6781 @ref{Export options}. | |
6782 @item #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO: | |
6783 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the | |
6784 current file. The corresponding variables are @code{org-todo-keywords} | |
6785 and @code{org-todo-interpretation}. | |
6786 @end table | |
6787 | |
6788 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous | |
6789 @section The very busy C-c C-c key | |
6790 @kindex C-c C-c | |
6791 @cindex C-c C-c, overview | |
6792 | |
6793 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in org-mode, which are all | |
6794 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of | |
6795 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many | |
6796 other circumstances it means something like @emph{Hey Org-mode, look | |
6797 here and update according to what you see here}. Here is a summary of | |
6798 what this means in different contexts. | |
6799 | |
6800 @itemize @minus | |
6801 @item | |
6802 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse | |
6803 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights. | |
6804 @item | |
6805 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this | |
6806 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the | |
6807 information. | |
6808 @item | |
6809 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command | |
6810 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off. | |
6811 @item | |
6812 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to | |
6813 the entire table. | |
6814 @item | |
6815 If the cursor is inside a table created by the @file{table.el} package, | |
6816 activate that table. | |
6817 @item | |
6818 If the current buffer is a remember buffer, close the note and file it. | |
6819 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the | |
6820 default location. | |
6821 @item | |
6822 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and | |
6823 corresponding links in this buffer. | |
6824 @item | |
6825 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property | |
6826 drawer, offer property commands. | |
6827 @item | |
6828 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status | |
6829 of the checkbox. | |
6830 @item | |
6831 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the | |
6832 ordered list. | |
6833 @end itemize | |
6834 | |
6835 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous | |
6836 @section A cleaner outline view | |
6837 @cindex hiding leading stars | |
6838 @cindex clean outline view | |
6839 | |
6840 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org-mode headlines | |
6841 are starting with a potentially large number of stars. For example | |
6842 the tree from @ref{Headlines}: | |
6843 | |
6844 @example | |
6845 * Top level headline | |
6846 ** Second level | |
6847 *** 3rd level | |
6848 some text | |
6849 *** 3rd level | |
6850 more text | |
6851 * Another top level headline | |
6852 @end example | |
6853 | |
6854 @noindent | |
6855 Unfortunately this is deeply ingrained into the code of Org-mode and | |
6856 cannot be easily changed. You can, however, modify the display in such | |
6857 a way that all leading stars become invisible and the outline more easy | |
6858 to read. To do this, customize the variable | |
6859 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} like this: | |
6860 | |
6861 @lisp | |
6862 (setq org-hide-leading-stars t) | |
6863 @end lisp | |
6864 | |
6865 @noindent | |
6866 or change this on a per-file basis with one of the lines (anywhere in | |
6867 the buffer) | |
6868 | |
6869 @example | |
6870 #+STARTUP: showstars | |
6871 #+STARTUP: hidestars | |
6872 @end example | |
6873 | |
6874 @noindent | |
6875 Press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in a @samp{STARTUP} line to activate | |
6876 the modifications. | |
6877 | |
6878 With stars hidden, the tree becomes: | |
6879 | |
6880 @example | |
6881 * Top level headline | |
6882 * Second level | |
6883 * 3rd level | |
6884 some text | |
6885 * 3rd level | |
6886 more text | |
6887 * Another top level headline | |
6888 @end example | |
6889 | |
6890 @noindent | |
6891 Note that the leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they | |
6892 are only fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the | |
6893 background color as font color. If you are not using either white or | |
6894 black background, you may have to customize this face to get the wanted | |
6895 effect. Another possibility is to set this font such that the extra | |
6896 stars are @i{almost} invisible, for example using the color | |
6897 @code{grey90} on a white background. | |
6898 | |
6899 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only | |
6900 odd levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one | |
6901 outline level to the next: | |
6902 | |
6903 @example | |
6904 * Top level headline | |
6905 * Second level | |
6906 * 3rd level | |
6907 some text | |
6908 * 3rd level | |
6909 more text | |
6910 * Another top level headline | |
6911 @end example | |
6912 | |
6913 @noindent | |
6914 In order to make the structure editing and export commands handle this | |
6915 convention correctly, use | |
6916 | |
6917 @lisp | |
6918 (setq org-odd-levels-only t) | |
6919 @end lisp | |
6920 | |
6921 @noindent | |
6922 or set this on a per-file basis with one of the following lines (don't | |
6923 forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in the startup line to | |
6924 activate changes immediately). | |
6925 | |
6926 @example | |
6927 #+STARTUP: odd | |
6928 #+STARTUP: oddeven | |
6929 @end example | |
6930 | |
6931 You can convert an Org-mode file from single-star-per-level to the | |
6932 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels | |
6933 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x | |
6934 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}. | |
6935 | |
6936 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous | |
6937 @section Using org-mode on a tty | |
6938 @cindex tty keybindings | |
6939 | |
6940 Org-mode uses a number of keys that are not accessible on a tty. This | |
6941 applies to most special keys like cursor keys, @key{TAB} and | |
6942 @key{RET}, when these are combined with modifier keys like @key{Meta} | |
6943 and/or @key{Shift}. Org-mode uses these bindings because it needs to | |
6944 provide keys for a large number of commands, and because these keys | |
6945 appeared particularly easy to remember. In order to still be able to | |
6946 access the core functionality of Org-mode on a tty, alternative | |
6947 bindings are provided. Here is a complete list of these bindings, | |
6948 which are obviously more cumbersome to use. Note that sometimes a | |
6949 work-around can be better. For example changing a time stamp is | |
6950 really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys. On a tty you would | |
6951 rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp. | |
6952 | |
6953 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.2 | |
6954 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Alternative 2} | |
6955 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab | |
6956 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}} | |
6957 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab | |
6958 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}} | |
6959 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab | |
6960 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}} | |
6961 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab | |
6962 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}} | |
6963 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab | |
6964 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab | |
6965 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}} | |
6966 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab | |
6967 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab | |
6968 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab | |
6969 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab | |
6970 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab | |
6971 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab | |
6972 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab | |
6973 @end multitable | |
6974 | |
6975 @node Interaction, Bugs, TTY keys, Miscellaneous | |
6976 @section Interaction with other packages | |
6977 @cindex packages, interaction with other | |
6978 Org-mode lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways | |
6979 with other code out there. | |
6980 | |
6981 @menu | |
6982 * Cooperation:: Packages Org-mode cooperates with | |
6983 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts | |
6984 @end menu | |
6985 | |
6986 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction | |
6987 @subsection Packages that Org-mode cooperates with | |
6988 | |
6989 @table @asis | |
6990 @cindex @file{calc.el} | |
6991 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie | |
6992 Org-mode uses the calc package for implementing spreadsheet | |
6993 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org-mode | |
6994 checks for the availability of calc by looking for the function | |
6995 @code{calc-eval} which should be autoloaded in your setup if calc has | |
6996 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, calc is part of the Emacs | |
6997 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two | |
6998 packages is using calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode, | |
6999 , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}. | |
7000 @cindex @file{constants.el} | |
7001 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik | |
7002 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use | |
7003 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own | |
7004 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install | |
7005 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants | |
7006 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for | |
7007 @samp{Mega} etc. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available | |
7008 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org-mode checks for | |
7009 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your | |
7010 setup. See the installation instructions in the file | |
7011 @file{constants.el}. | |
7012 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik | |
7013 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el} | |
7014 Org-mode can make use of the cdlatex package to efficiently enter | |
7015 La@TeX{} fragments into Org-mode files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}. | |
7016 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley | |
7017 @cindex @file{remember.el} | |
7018 Org mode cooperates with remember, see @ref{Remember}. | |
7019 @file{Remember.el} is not part of Emacs, find it on the web. | |
7020 @cindex @file{table.el} | |
7021 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota | |
7022 @kindex C-c C-c | |
7023 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el} | |
7024 @cindex @file{table.el} | |
7025 | |
7026 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and | |
7027 row-spanning, and alignment can be created using the Emacs table | |
7028 package by Takaaki Ota (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, | |
7029 and also part of Emacs 22). | |
7030 When @key{TAB} or @kbd{C-c C-c} is pressed in such a table, Org-mode | |
7031 will call @command{table-recognize-table} and move the cursor into the | |
7032 table. Inside a table, the keymap of Org-mode is inactive. In order | |
7033 to execute Org-mode-related commands, leave the table. | |
7034 | |
7035 @table @kbd | |
7036 @kindex C-c C-c | |
7037 @item C-c C-c | |
7038 Recognize @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a | |
7039 table.el table. | |
7040 @c | |
7041 @kindex C-c ~ | |
7042 @item C-c ~ | |
7043 Insert a table.el table. If there is already a table at point, this | |
7044 command converts it between the table.el format and the Org-mode | |
7045 format. See the documentation string of the command | |
7046 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is | |
7047 possible. | |
7048 @end table | |
7049 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs 22. | |
7050 @cindex @file{footnote.el} | |
7051 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur | |
7052 Org-mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package | |
7053 (@pxref{Footnotes}). | |
7054 @end table | |
7055 | |
7056 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction | |
7057 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org-mode | |
7058 | |
7059 @table @asis | |
7060 | |
7061 @cindex @file{allout.el} | |
7062 @item @file{allout.el} by Ken Manheimer | |
7063 Startup of Org-mode may fail with the error message | |
7064 @code{(wrong-type-argument keymapp nil)} when there is an outdated | |
7065 version @file{allout.el} on the load path, for example the version | |
7066 distributed with Emacs 21.x. Upgrade to Emacs 22 and this problem will | |
7067 disappear. If for some reason you cannot do this, make sure that org.el | |
7068 is loaded @emph{before} @file{allout.el}, for example by putting | |
7069 @code{(require 'org)} early enough into your @file{.emacs} file. | |
7070 | |
7071 @cindex @file{CUA.el} | |
7072 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm | |
7073 Keybindings in Org-mode conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys | |
7074 used by CUA-mode (as well as pc-select-mode and s-region-mode) to | |
7075 select and extend the region. If you want to use one of these | |
7076 packages along with Org-mode, configure the variable | |
7077 @code{org-CUA-compatible}. When set, Org-mode will move the following | |
7078 keybindings in Org-mode files, and in the agenda buffer (but not | |
7079 during date selection). | |
7080 | |
7081 @example | |
7082 S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n | |
7083 S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+ | |
7084 @end example | |
7085 | |
7086 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want | |
7087 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable | |
7088 @code{org-disputed-keys}. | |
7089 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham | |
7090 @cindex @file{windmove.el} | |
7091 Also this package uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written | |
7092 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. | |
7093 | |
7094 @cindex @file{footnote.el} | |
7095 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur | |
7096 Org-mode supports the syntax of the footnote package, but only the | |
7097 numerical footnote markers. Also, the default key for footnote | |
7098 commands, @kbd{C-c !} is already used by Org-mode. You could use the | |
7099 variable @code{footnote-prefix} to switch footnotes commands to another | |
7100 key. Or, you could use @code{org-replace-disputed-keys} and | |
7101 @code{org-disputed-keys} to change the settings in Org-mode. | |
7102 | |
7103 @end table | |
7104 | |
7105 | |
7106 @node Bugs, , Interaction, Miscellaneous | |
7107 @section Bugs | |
7108 @cindex bugs | |
7109 | |
7110 Here is a list of things that should work differently, but which I | |
7111 have found too hard to fix. | |
7112 | |
7113 @itemize @bullet | |
7114 @item | |
7115 If a table field starts with a link, and if the corresponding table | |
7116 column is narrowed (@pxref{Narrow columns}) to a width too small to | |
7117 display the link, the field would look entirely empty even though it is | |
7118 not. To prevent this, Org-mode throws an error. The work-around is to | |
7119 make the column wide enough to fit the link, or to add some text (at | |
7120 least 2 characters) before the link in the same field. | |
7121 @item | |
7122 Narrowing table columns does not work on XEmacs, because the | |
7123 @code{format} function does not transport text properties. | |
7124 @item | |
7125 Text in an entry protected with the @samp{QUOTE} keyword should not | |
7126 autowrap. | |
7127 @item | |
7128 When the application called by @kbd{C-c C-o} to open a file link fails | |
7129 (for example because the application does not exist or refuses to open | |
7130 the file), it does so silently. No error message is displayed. | |
7131 @item | |
7132 Recalculating a table line applies the formulas from left to right. | |
7133 If a formula uses @emph{calculated} fields further down the row, | |
7134 multiple recalculation may be needed to get all fields consistent. You | |
7135 may use the command @code{org-table-iterate} (@kbd{C-u C-c *}) to | |
7136 recalculate until convergence. | |
7137 @item | |
7138 A single letter cannot be made bold, for example @samp{*a*}. | |
7139 @item | |
7140 The exporters work well, but could be made more efficient. | |
7141 @end itemize | |
7142 | |
7143 | |
7144 @node Extensions and Hacking, History and Acknowledgments, Miscellaneous, Top | |
7145 @appendix Extensions, Hooks and Hacking | |
7146 | |
7147 This appendix lists extensions for Org-mode written by other authors. | |
7148 It also covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of | |
7149 Org-mode. | |
7150 | |
7151 @menu | |
7152 * Extensions:: Existing 3rd-part extensions | |
7153 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types | |
7154 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs | |
7155 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks | |
7156 * Special agenda views:: Customized views | |
7157 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties | |
7158 @end menu | |
7159 | |
7160 @node Extensions, Adding hyperlink types, Extensions and Hacking, Extensions and Hacking | |
7161 @section Third-party extensions for Org-mode | |
7162 @cindex extension, third-party | |
7163 | |
7164 The following extensions for Org-mode have been written by other people: | |
7165 | |
7166 @table @asis | |
7167 @cindex @file{org-publish.el} | |
7168 @item @file{org-publish.el} by David O'Toole | |
7169 This package provides facilities for publishing related sets of Org-mode | |
7170 files together with linked files like images as webpages. It is | |
7171 highly configurable and can be used for other publishing purposes as | |
7172 well. As of Org-mode version 4.30, @file{org-publish.el} is part of the | |
7173 Org-mode distribution. It is not yet part of Emacs, however, a delay | |
7174 caused by the preparations for the 22.1 release. In the mean time, | |
7175 @file{org-publish.el} can be downloaded from David's site: | |
7176 @url{http://dto.freeshell.org/e/org-publish.el}. | |
7177 @cindex @file{org-mouse.el} | |
7178 @item @file{org-mouse.el} by Piotr Zielinski | |
7179 This package implements extended mouse functionality for Org-mode. It | |
7180 allows you to cycle visibility and to edit the document structure with | |
7181 the mouse. Best of all, it provides a context-sensitive menu on | |
7182 @key{mouse-3} that changes depending on the context of a mouse-click. | |
7183 As of Org-mode version 4.53, @file{org-mouse.el} is part of the | |
7184 Org-mode distribution. It is not yet part of Emacs, however, a delay | |
7185 caused by the preparations for the 22.1 release. In the mean time, | |
7186 @file{org-mouse.el} can be downloaded from Piotr's site: | |
7187 @url{http://www.cl.cam.ac.uk/~pz215/files/org-mouse.el}. | |
7188 @cindex @file{org-blog.el} | |
7189 @item @file{org-blog.el} by David O'Toole | |
7190 A blogging plug-in for @file{org-publish.el}.@* | |
7191 @url{http://dto.freeshell.org/notebook/OrgMode.html}. | |
7192 @cindex @file{blorg.el} | |
7193 @item @file{blorg.el} by Bastien Guerry | |
7194 Publish Org-mode files as | |
7195 blogs. @url{http://www.cognition.ens.fr/~guerry/blorg.html}. | |
7196 @cindex @file{org2rem.el} | |
7197 @item @file{org2rem.el} by Bastien Guerry | |
7198 Translates Org-mode files into something readable by | |
7199 Remind. @url{http://www.cognition.ens.fr/~guerry/u/org2rem.el}. | |
7200 @end table | |
7201 | |
7202 @page | |
7203 | |
7204 @node Adding hyperlink types, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Extensions, Extensions and Hacking | |
7205 @section Adding hyperlink types | |
7206 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types | |
7207 | |
7208 Org-mode has a large number of hyperlink types built-in | |
7209 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, it | |
7210 provides an interface for doing so. Lets look at an example file | |
7211 @file{org-man.el} that will add support for creating links like | |
7212 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show unix manual pages inside | |
7213 emacs: | |
7214 | |
7215 @lisp | |
7216 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org-mode | |
7217 | |
7218 (require 'org) | |
7219 | |
7220 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open) | |
7221 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link) | |
7222 | |
7223 (defcustom org-man-command 'man | |
7224 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page." | |
7225 :group 'org-link | |
7226 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman))) | |
7227 | |
7228 (defun org-man-open (path) | |
7229 "Visit the manpage on PATH. | |
7230 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command." | |
7231 (funcall org-man-command path)) | |
7232 | |
7233 (defun org-man-store-link () | |
7234 "Store a link to a manpage." | |
7235 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode)) | |
7236 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link | |
7237 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name)) | |
7238 (link (concat "man:" page)) | |
7239 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page))) | |
7240 (org-store-link-props | |
7241 :type "man" | |
7242 :link link | |
7243 :description description)))) | |
7244 | |
7245 (defun org-man-get-page-name () | |
7246 "Extract the page name from the buffer name." | |
7247 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'. | |
7248 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name)) | |
7249 (match-string 1 (buffer-name)) | |
7250 (error "Cannot create link to this man page"))) | |
7251 | |
7252 (provide 'org-man) | |
7253 | |
7254 ;;; org-man.el ends here | |
7255 @end lisp | |
7256 | |
7257 @noindent | |
7258 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with | |
7259 | |
7260 @lisp | |
7261 (require 'org-man) | |
7262 @end lisp | |
7263 | |
7264 @noindent | |
7265 Lets go through the file and see what it does. | |
7266 @enumerate | |
7267 @item | |
7268 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been | |
7269 loaded. | |
7270 @item | |
7271 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type | |
7272 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function | |
7273 that will be called to follow such a link. | |
7274 @item | |
7275 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in | |
7276 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a | |
7277 buffer displaying a man page. | |
7278 @end enumerate | |
7279 | |
7280 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions. | |
7281 First there is a customization variable that determines which emacs | |
7282 command should be used to display manpages. There are two options, | |
7283 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is | |
7284 defined. It gets the link path as an argument - in this case the link | |
7285 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the | |
7286 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page. | |
7287 | |
7288 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try | |
7289 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, also this function will be called to | |
7290 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to | |
7291 create the link for this buffer type, we do this by checking the value | |
7292 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and | |
7293 retunr the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the | |
7294 manual tpoic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string | |
7295 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props} | |
7296 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you | |
7297 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for | |
7298 the link description when the link is later inserted into tan Org-mode | |
7299 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}. | |
7300 | |
7301 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Adding hyperlink types, Extensions and Hacking | |
7302 @section Tables in arbitrary syntax | |
7303 @cindex tables, in other modes | |
7304 @cindex orgtbl-mode | |
7305 | |
7306 Since Orgtbl-mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a | |
7307 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in | |
7308 specific languages, for example La@TeX{}. However, this is extremely hard | |
7309 to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare, and | |
7310 would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl-mode table editor. | |
7311 | |
7312 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl-mode | |
7313 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom | |
7314 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to | |
7315 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts | |
7316 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows | |
7317 for a very flexible system. | |
7318 | |
7319 @menu | |
7320 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving | |
7321 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial | |
7322 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify | |
7323 @end menu | |
7324 | |
7325 @node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax | |
7326 @subsection Radio tables | |
7327 @cindex radio tables | |
7328 | |
7329 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two | |
7330 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for | |
7331 Orgtbl-mode to find. Orgtbl-mode will insert the translated table | |
7332 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example: | |
7333 | |
7334 @example | |
7335 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */ | |
7336 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */ | |
7337 @end example | |
7338 | |
7339 @noindent | |
7340 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells | |
7341 Orgtbl-mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For | |
7342 example: | |
7343 @example | |
7344 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments.... | |
7345 @end example | |
7346 | |
7347 @noindent | |
7348 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used | |
7349 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function | |
7350 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of | |
7351 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be | |
7352 passed as a property list to the translation function for | |
7353 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and | |
7354 acted upon before the translation function is called: | |
7355 | |
7356 @table @code | |
7357 @item :skip N | |
7358 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count! | |
7359 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...) | |
7360 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with | |
7361 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well. | |
7362 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the | |
7363 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been | |
7364 additional columns. | |
7365 @end table | |
7366 | |
7367 @noindent | |
7368 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer | |
7369 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during | |
7370 compilation of a C file or processing of a La@TeX{} file. There are a | |
7371 number of different solutions: | |
7372 | |
7373 @itemize @bullet | |
7374 @item | |
7375 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the | |
7376 language. For example, in C-mode you could wrap the table between | |
7377 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines. | |
7378 @item | |
7379 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END} | |
7380 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in TeX and @samp{\end@{document@}} | |
7381 in La@TeX{}. | |
7382 @item | |
7383 You can just comment the table line by line whenever you want to process | |
7384 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This | |
7385 only sounds tedious - the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment} does | |
7386 make this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a | |
7387 key. | |
7388 @end itemize | |
7389 | |
7390 @node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax | |
7391 @subsection A LaTeX example | |
7392 @cindex LaTeX, and orgtbl-mode | |
7393 | |
7394 The best way to wrap the source table in La@TeX{} is to use the | |
7395 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be | |
7396 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document | |
7397 header. Orgtbl-mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By | |
7398 default this works only for La@TeX{}, HTML, and TeXInfo. Configure the | |
7399 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other | |
7400 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will | |
7401 be prompted for a table name, lets say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You | |
7402 will then get the following template: | |
7403 | |
7404 @example | |
7405 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures | |
7406 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures | |
7407 \begin@{comment@} | |
7408 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex | |
7409 | | | | |
7410 \end@{comment@} | |
7411 @end example | |
7412 | |
7413 @noindent | |
7414 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells orgtbl-mode to use the function | |
7415 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into La@TeX{} and to put it | |
7416 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now | |
7417 fill in the table, feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If | |
7418 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters, | |
7419 this may cause problems with font-lock in latex-mode. As shown in the | |
7420 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the | |
7421 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar | |
7422 expressions. If you are using AUCTeX with the font-latex library, a | |
7423 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the | |
7424 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}: | |
7425 | |
7426 @example | |
7427 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures | |
7428 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures | |
7429 \begin@{comment@} | |
7430 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex | |
7431 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day | | |
7432 |-------+------+---------+---------| | |
7433 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 | | |
7434 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 | | |
7435 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 | | |
7436 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f | |
7437 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote) | |
7438 \end@{comment@} | |
7439 @end example | |
7440 | |
7441 @noindent | |
7442 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted | |
7443 table inserted between the two marker lines. | |
7444 | |
7445 Now lets assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you | |
7446 want to control how columns are aligned etc. In this case we make sure | |
7447 that the table translator does skip the first 2 lines of the source | |
7448 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e. to not produce | |
7449 header and footer commands of the target table: | |
7450 | |
7451 @example | |
7452 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@} | |
7453 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\ | |
7454 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures | |
7455 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures | |
7456 \end@{tabular@} | |
7457 % | |
7458 \begin@{comment@} | |
7459 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2 | |
7460 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day | | |
7461 |-------+------+---------+---------| | |
7462 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 | | |
7463 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 | | |
7464 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 | | |
7465 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f | |
7466 \end@{comment@} | |
7467 @end example | |
7468 | |
7469 The La@TeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of | |
7470 Orgtbl-mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table | |
7471 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it | |
7472 interprets the following parameters: | |
7473 | |
7474 @table @code | |
7475 @item :splice nil/t | |
7476 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a | |
7477 tabular environment. Default is nil. | |
7478 | |
7479 @item :fmt fmt | |
7480 A format to be used to wrap each field, should contain @code{%s} for the | |
7481 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars, | |
7482 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with | |
7483 column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}. | |
7484 | |
7485 @item :efmt efmt | |
7486 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should | |
7487 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example | |
7488 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This | |
7489 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example | |
7490 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After | |
7491 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be | |
7492 applied. | |
7493 @end table | |
7494 | |
7495 @node Translator functions, , A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax | |
7496 @subsection Translator functions | |
7497 @cindex HTML, and orgtbl-mode | |
7498 @cindex translator function | |
7499 | |
7500 Orgtbl-mode has several translator functions built-in: | |
7501 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and | |
7502 @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}. Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The | |
7503 HTML translator uses the same code that produces tables during HTML | |
7504 export.}, these all use a generic translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. | |
7505 For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex} itself is a very short function that | |
7506 computes the column definitions for the @code{tabular} environment, | |
7507 defines a few field and line separators and then hands over to the | |
7508 generic translator. Here is the entire code: | |
7509 | |
7510 @lisp | |
7511 @group | |
7512 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params) | |
7513 "Convert the orgtbl-mode TABLE to LaTeX." | |
7514 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l")) | |
7515 org-table-last-alignment "")) | |
7516 (params2 | |
7517 (list | |
7518 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}") | |
7519 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}" | |
7520 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & " | |
7521 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline"))) | |
7522 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params)))) | |
7523 @end group | |
7524 @end lisp | |
7525 | |
7526 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable | |
7527 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function | |
7528 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the | |
7529 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you | |
7530 would like to use the La@TeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to | |
7531 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just | |
7532 overrule the default with | |
7533 | |
7534 @example | |
7535 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]" | |
7536 @end example | |
7537 | |
7538 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in | |
7539 analogy with the La@TeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function | |
7540 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started | |
7541 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are | |
7542 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!} and where the field | |
7543 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on | |
7544 a single line!): | |
7545 | |
7546 @example | |
7547 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!" | |
7548 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t" | |
7549 @end example | |
7550 | |
7551 @noindent | |
7552 Please check the documentation string of the function | |
7553 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by | |
7554 that function and remember that you can pass each of them into | |
7555 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function | |
7556 using the generic function. | |
7557 | |
7558 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated | |
7559 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes | |
7560 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each | |
7561 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second | |
7562 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the | |
7563 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string | |
7564 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful | |
7565 translator, please post it on @code{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that | |
7566 others can benefit from your work. | |
7567 | |
7568 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Extensions and Hacking | |
7569 @section Dynamic blocks | |
7570 @cindex dynamic blocks | |
7571 | |
7572 Org-mode documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are | |
7573 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function. | |
7574 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the | |
7575 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}). | |
7576 | |
7577 Dynamic block are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name | |
7578 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing | |
7579 the content of the block. | |
7580 | |
7581 @example | |
7582 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ... | |
7583 | |
7584 #+END: | |
7585 @end example | |
7586 | |
7587 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands | |
7588 | |
7589 @table @kbd | |
7590 @kindex C-c C-x C-u | |
7591 @item C-c C-x C-u | |
7592 Update dynamic block at point. | |
7593 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u | |
7594 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u | |
7595 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file. | |
7596 @end table | |
7597 | |
7598 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and | |
7599 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific | |
7600 writer function for this block to insert the new content. For a block | |
7601 with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is | |
7602 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list | |
7603 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example | |
7604 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last | |
7605 run: | |
7606 | |
7607 @example | |
7608 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M" | |
7609 | |
7610 #+END: | |
7611 @end example | |
7612 | |
7613 @noindent | |
7614 The corresponding block writer function could look like this: | |
7615 | |
7616 @lisp | |
7617 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params) | |
7618 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y"))) | |
7619 (insert "Last block update at: " | |
7620 (format-time-string fmt (current-time))))) | |
7621 @end lisp | |
7622 | |
7623 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date, | |
7624 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for | |
7625 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is | |
7626 written in a way that is does nothing in buffers that are not in Org-mode. | |
7627 | |
7628 @node Special agenda views, Using the property API, Dynamic blocks, Extensions and Hacking | |
7629 @section Special Agenda Views | |
7630 @cindex agenda views, user-defined | |
7631 | |
7632 Org-mode provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the | |
7633 selection made by any of the agenda views. You may specify a function | |
7634 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part | |
7635 of the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped. | |
7636 | |
7637 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING | |
7638 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have | |
7639 marked all tree headings that define a project with the todo keyword | |
7640 PROJECT. In this case you would run a todo search for the keyword | |
7641 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in | |
7642 the subtree belonging to the project line. | |
7643 | |
7644 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for | |
7645 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to | |
7646 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such | |
7647 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that | |
7648 search should continue from there. | |
7649 | |
7650 @lisp | |
7651 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting () | |
7652 "Skip trees that are not waiting" | |
7653 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t)))) | |
7654 (if (re-search-forward ":WAITING:" subtree-end t) | |
7655 nil ; tag found, do not skip | |
7656 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree | |
7657 @end lisp | |
7658 | |
7659 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example | |
7660 like this: | |
7661 | |
7662 @lisp | |
7663 (org-add-agenda-custom-command | |
7664 '("b" todo "PROJECT" | |
7665 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-org-waiting-projects) | |
7666 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: ")))) | |
7667 @end lisp | |
7668 | |
7669 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a | |
7670 meaningful header in the agenda view. | |
7671 | |
7672 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In | |
7673 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if} | |
7674 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example: | |
7675 | |
7676 @table @code | |
7677 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled) | |
7678 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled. | |
7679 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled) | |
7680 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled. | |
7681 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline) | |
7682 Skip current entry if it has a deadline. | |
7683 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline) | |
7684 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled. | |
7685 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression") | |
7686 Skip current entry if the regular expression contained in the variable | |
7687 @code{org-agenda-skip-regexp} matches in the entry. | |
7688 @item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression") | |
7689 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree. | |
7690 @end table | |
7691 | |
7692 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects | |
7693 like this, even without defining a special function: | |
7694 | |
7695 @lisp | |
7696 (org-add-agenda-custom-command | |
7697 '("b" todo "PROJECT" | |
7698 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if | |
7699 'regexp ":WAITING:")) | |
7700 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: ")))) | |
7701 @end lisp | |
7702 | |
7703 | |
7704 @node Using the property API, , Special agenda views, Extensions and Hacking | |
7705 @section Using the property API | |
7706 @cindex API, for properties | |
7707 @cindex properties, API | |
7708 | |
7709 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with | |
7710 properties. | |
7711 | |
7712 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which | |
7713 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM. | |
7714 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline, | |
7715 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the | |
7716 entry. The return value is an alist, keys may occur multiple times | |
7717 if the property key was used several times. | |
7718 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used. | |
7719 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is | |
7720 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass. | |
7721 @end defun | |
7722 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit | |
7723 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. | |
7724 If INHERIT is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, | |
7725 then also check higher levels of the hierarchy. | |
7726 @end defun | |
7727 | |
7728 @defun org-entry-delete pom property | |
7729 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM. | |
7730 @end defun | |
7731 | |
7732 @defun org-entry-put pom property value | |
7733 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM. | |
7734 @end defun | |
7735 | |
7736 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials | |
7737 Get all property keys in the current buffer. | |
7738 @end defun | |
7739 | |
7740 @defun org-insert-property-drawer | |
7741 Insert a property drawer at point. | |
7742 @end defun | |
7743 | |
7744 @node History and Acknowledgments, Index, Extensions and Hacking, Top | |
7745 @appendix History and Acknowledgments | |
7746 @cindex acknowledgments | |
7747 @cindex history | |
7748 @cindex thanks | |
7749 | |
7750 Org-mode was borne in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface | |
7751 of the Emacs outline-mode. I was trying to organize my notes and | |
7752 projects, and using Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, | |
7753 having to remember eleven different commands with two or three keys per | |
7754 command, only to hide and unhide parts of the outline tree, that seemed | |
7755 entirely unacceptable to me. Also, when using outlines to take notes, I | |
7756 constantly want to restructure the tree, organizing it parallel to my | |
7757 thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility cycling} and @emph{structure | |
7758 editing} were originally implemented in the package | |
7759 @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general | |
7760 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project | |
7761 planning, the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{time | |
7762 stamps}, and @emph{table support}. These areas highlight the two main | |
7763 goals that Org-mode still has today: To create a new, outline-based, | |
7764 plain text mode with innovative and intuitive editing features, and to | |
7765 incorporate project planning functionality directly into a notes file. | |
7766 | |
7767 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or on | |
7768 @code{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug | |
7769 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code. | |
7770 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am | |
7771 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence | |
7772 in shaping one or more aspects of Org-mode. The list may not be | |
7773 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and | |
7774 let me know. | |
7775 | |
7776 @itemize @bullet | |
7777 | |
7778 @item | |
7779 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers. | |
7780 @item | |
7781 @i{Thomas Baumann} contributed the code for links to the MH-E email | |
7782 system. | |
7783 @item | |
7784 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding time stamps. | |
7785 @item | |
7786 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates | |
7787 for Remember. | |
7788 @item | |
7789 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with | |
7790 specified time. | |
7791 @item | |
7792 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for lisp forms into table | |
7793 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting | |
7794 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs. | |
7795 @item | |
7796 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested to copy some linking code from Planner. | |
7797 @item | |
7798 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also | |
7799 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for | |
7800 them. | |
7801 @item | |
7802 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so | |
7803 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also | |
7804 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns. | |
7805 @item | |
7806 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into TeXInfo format, | |
7807 patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and inspired the agenda. | |
7808 @item | |
7809 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported | |
7810 HTML agendas. | |
7811 @item | |
7812 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support. | |
7813 @item | |
7814 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context | |
7815 around a match in a hidden outline tree. | |
7816 @item | |
7817 @i{Niels Giessen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees. | |
7818 @item | |
7819 @i{Bastien Guerry} wrote the La@TeX{} exporter and has been prolific | |
7820 with patches, ideas, and bug reports. | |
7821 to Org-mode. | |
7822 @item | |
7823 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages. | |
7824 @item | |
7825 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between | |
7826 folded entries, and column view for properties. | |
7827 @item | |
7828 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded La@TeX{} and tested it. He also | |
7829 provided frequent feedback and some patches. | |
7830 @item | |
7831 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format. | |
7832 @item | |
7833 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file | |
7834 basis. | |
7835 @item | |
7836 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler | |
7837 happy. | |
7838 @item | |
7839 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed to allow multiple TODO sequences in a file. | |
7840 @item | |
7841 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and elisp forms. | |
7842 @item | |
7843 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general | |
7844 file links, and TAGS. | |
7845 @item | |
7846 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial | |
7847 into Japanese. | |
7848 @item | |
7849 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items. | |
7850 @item | |
7851 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for | |
7852 links, among other things. | |
7853 @item | |
7854 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and | |
7855 provided frequent feedback. | |
7856 @item | |
7857 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements. | |
7858 @item | |
7859 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality | |
7860 control. | |
7861 @item | |
7862 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts. | |
7863 @item | |
7864 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a | |
7865 conflict with @file{allout.el}. | |
7866 @item | |
7867 @i{Jason Riedy} sent a patch to fix a bug with export of TODO keywords. | |
7868 @item | |
7869 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org-mode reference card and provided lots | |
7870 of feedback. | |
7871 @item | |
7872 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among | |
7873 other things. | |
7874 @item | |
7875 Linking to VM/BBDB/GNUS was inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s | |
7876 @file{organizer-mode.el}. | |
7877 @item | |
7878 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking | |
7879 subtrees. | |
7880 @item | |
7881 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations. | |
7882 @item | |
7883 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands and inspired the link | |
7884 extension system. support mairix. | |
7885 @item | |
7886 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual | |
7887 chapter about publishing. | |
7888 @item | |
7889 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents | |
7890 in HTML output. | |
7891 @item | |
7892 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE} | |
7893 keyword. | |
7894 @item | |
7895 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking | |
7896 system. | |
7897 @item | |
7898 @i{John Wiegley} wrote @file{emacs-wiki.el} and @file{planner.el}. The | |
7899 development of Org-mode was fully independent, and both systems are | |
7900 really different beasts in their basic ideas and implementation details. | |
7901 I later looked at John's code, however, and learned from his | |
7902 implementation of (i) links where the link itself is hidden and only a | |
7903 description is shown, and (ii) popping up a calendar to select a date. | |
7904 John has also contributed a number of great ideas directly to Org-mode. | |
7905 @item | |
7906 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in | |
7907 linking to GNUS. | |
7908 @item | |
7909 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional keybindings to make Org-mode | |
7910 work on a tty. | |
7911 @item | |
7912 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks | |
7913 and contributed various ideas and code snippets. | |
7914 @end itemize | |
7915 | |
7916 | |
7917 @node Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top | |
7918 @unnumbered Index | |
7919 | |
7920 @printindex cp | |
7921 | |
7922 @node Key Index, , Index, Top | |
7923 @unnumbered Key Index | |
7924 | |
7925 @printindex ky | |
7926 | |
7927 @bye | |
7928 | |
7929 @ignore | |
7930 arch-tag: 7893d1fe-cc57-4d13-b5e5-f494a1bcc7ac | |
7931 @end ignore |